blob: 8393a15be37b89f36a644903da6e0efb4551ac0e [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file was developed by the LLVM research group and is distributed under
6// the University of Illinois Open Source License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG This pass is where algebraic
12// simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Duncan Sandsb84abcd2007-09-11 14:35:41 +000042#include "llvm/ParameterAttributes.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000048#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000049#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000050#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000051#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000052#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000053#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000054#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000059#include <algorithm>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000060#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000061using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000062using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000063
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000064STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
65STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
66STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
67STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
68STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000069
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000070namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000071 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
72 : public FunctionPass,
73 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000074 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000075 std::vector<Instruction*> Worklist;
76 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000077 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000078 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000079 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000080 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000081 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass((intptr_t)&ID) {}
82
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000083 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
84 /// isn't already in it.
85 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
86 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())))
87 Worklist.push_back(I);
88 }
89
90 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
91 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
92 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
93 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
94
95 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
96 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
97
98 WorklistMap.erase(It);
99 }
100
101 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
102 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
103 Worklist.pop_back();
104 WorklistMap.erase(I);
105 return I;
106 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000107
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000108
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000109 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
110 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
111 /// now.
112 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000113 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000114 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000115 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000116 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 }
118
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000119 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
120 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
121 ///
122 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
123 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
124 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i)))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000125 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000126 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000127
128 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
129 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
130 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
131 ///
132 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
133 ///
134 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
135 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
136
137 for (unsigned i = 0, e = I.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
138 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000139 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000140 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
141 I.setOperand(i, UndefValue::get(Op->getType()));
142 }
143
144 return R;
145 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000146
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000147 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000148 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000149
150 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000151
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000152 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000153 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000154 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000155 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000156 }
157
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000158 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
159
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000160 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
161 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
162 // Return Value:
163 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000164 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000165 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000166 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000167 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
168 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
169 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000170 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
172 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000175 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
176 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
178 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000180 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000183 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
184 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
186 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000187 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
188 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
189 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000190 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
191 Instruction *LHS,
192 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000193 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
194 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000195
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000196 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
197 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000198 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000199 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000200 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
201 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000202 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000203 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
204 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
205 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000206 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI);
207 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
208 Instruction *visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI);
209 Instruction *visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI);
210 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
211 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
212 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
213 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000214 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000215 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
216 Instruction *FI);
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +0000217 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &CI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000218 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
219 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000220 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
221 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000222 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000223 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000224 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000225 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000226 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000227 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000228 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000229 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000230 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000231
232 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000233 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000234
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000235 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000236 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000237 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
238
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000239 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000240 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
241 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
242 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000243 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000244 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
245 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000246 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
247 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000248 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000249 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000250 }
251
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000252 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
253 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
254 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000255 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
256 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000257 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000258
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000259 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000260 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000261
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000262 Instruction *C = CastInst::create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000263 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000264 return C;
265 }
266
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000267 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
268 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
269 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
270 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
271 // modified.
272 //
273 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000274 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000275 if (&I != V) {
276 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
277 return &I;
278 } else {
279 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
280 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000281 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000282 return &I;
283 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000284 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000285
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000286 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
287 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
288 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
289 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
290 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
291 //
292 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
293 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
294 if (Old != New)
295 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
296 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000297 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000298 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000299 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000300 return true;
301 }
302
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000303 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
304 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
305 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
306 // this function.
307 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
308 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
309 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000310 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000311 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000312 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
313 }
314
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000315 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000316 /// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
317 /// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
318 /// casts that are known to not do anything...
319 ///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000320 Value *InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
321 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000322 Instruction *InsertBefore);
323
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000324 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
325 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000326 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000327
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000328 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
329 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
330 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
331
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000332 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
333 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000334 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
335 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
336 unsigned Depth = 0);
337
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000338 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
339 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
340
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000341 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
342 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
343 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
344 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
345
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000346 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
347 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
348 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
349 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000350 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
351
352
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000353 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
354 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000355
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000356 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000357 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000358 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000359 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000360 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000361 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000362 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000363
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000364 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000365 };
Chris Lattnerf6293092002-07-23 18:06:35 +0000366
Devang Patel19974732007-05-03 01:11:54 +0000367 char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
Chris Lattner7f8897f2006-08-27 22:42:52 +0000368 RegisterPass<InstCombiner> X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000369}
370
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000371// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000372// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000373static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
374 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
375 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000376 return 3;
377 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000378 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000379 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
380 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000381}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000382
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000383// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
384// it.
385static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000386 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000387}
388
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000389// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
390// though a va_arg area...
391static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000392 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
393 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
394 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000395 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000396 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000397}
398
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000399/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst or a constant
400/// expression bitcast, return the operand value, otherwise return null.
401static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
402 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000403 return I->getOperand(0);
404 else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000405 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000406 return CE->getOperand(0);
407 return 0;
408}
409
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000410/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
411/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000412static Instruction::CastOps
413isEliminableCastPair(
414 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
415 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
416 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
417 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
418) {
419
420 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
421 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000422
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000423 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
424 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
425 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000426
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000427 return Instruction::CastOps(
428 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
429 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000430}
431
432/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
433/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
434/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000435static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
436 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000437 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
438
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000439 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000440 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000441 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000442 return false;
443 return true;
444}
445
446/// InsertOperandCastBefore - This inserts a cast of V to DestTy before the
447/// InsertBefore instruction. This is specialized a bit to avoid inserting
448/// casts that are known to not do anything...
449///
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000450Value *InstCombiner::InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opcode,
451 Value *V, const Type *DestTy,
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000452 Instruction *InsertBefore) {
453 if (V->getType() == DestTy) return V;
454 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000455 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, DestTy);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000456
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000457 return InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DestTy, *InsertBefore);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000458}
459
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000460// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
461// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000462//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000463// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
464// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
465// binary operators.
466//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000467// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
468// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000469//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000470bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000471 bool Changed = false;
472 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
473 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000474
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000475 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
476 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000477 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
478 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
479 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000480 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
481 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
482 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000483 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
484 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
485 return true;
486 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
487 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
488 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
489 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
490 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
491
492 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000493 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000494 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
495 Op1->getOperand(0),
496 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000497 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000498 I.setOperand(0, New);
499 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
500 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000501 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000502 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000503 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000504}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000505
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000506/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
507/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
508/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
509bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
510 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
511 return false;
512 I.swapOperands();
513 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
514 return true;
515}
516
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000517// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
518// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000519//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000520static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
521 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000522 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000523
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000524 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
525 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
526 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000527 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000528}
529
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000530static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
531 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000532 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000533
534 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000535 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000536 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000537 return 0;
538}
539
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000540// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
541// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000542// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
543// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000544//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000545static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000546 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000547 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000548 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000549 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000550 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000551 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000552 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000553 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000554 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000555 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000556 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000557 return I->getOperand(0);
558 }
559 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000560 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000561}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000562
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000563/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
564/// expression, return it.
565static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
566 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
567 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
568 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
569 return cast<User>(V);
570 return false;
571}
572
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000573/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000574static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000575 APInt Val(C->getValue());
576 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000577}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000578/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000579static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000580 APInt Val(C->getValue());
581 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000582}
583/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
584static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
585 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
586}
587/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
588static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
589 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
590}
591/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
592static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
593 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
594}
595/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
596static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
597 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000598}
599
Chris Lattner68d5ff22006-02-09 07:38:58 +0000600/// ComputeMaskedBits - Determine which of the bits specified in Mask are
601/// known to be either zero or one and return them in the KnownZero/KnownOne
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000602/// bit sets. This code only analyzes bits in Mask, in order to short-circuit
603/// processing.
604/// NOTE: we cannot consider 'undef' to be "IsZero" here. The problem is that
605/// we cannot optimize based on the assumption that it is zero without changing
606/// it to be an explicit zero. If we don't change it to zero, other code could
607/// optimized based on the contradictory assumption that it is non-zero.
608/// Because instcombine aggressively folds operations with undef args anyway,
609/// this won't lose us code quality.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +0000610static void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000611 APInt& KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000612 assert(V && "No Value?");
613 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000614 uint32_t BitWidth = Mask.getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000615 assert(cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000616 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000617 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000618 "V, Mask, KnownOne and KnownZero should have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000619 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
620 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000621 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & Mask;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000622 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & Mask;
623 return;
624 }
625
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000626 if (Depth == 6 || Mask == 0)
627 return; // Limit search depth.
628
629 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
630 if (!I) return;
631
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000632 KnownZero.clear(); KnownOne.clear(); // Don't know anything.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000633 APInt KnownZero2(KnownZero), KnownOne2(KnownOne);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000634
635 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000636 case Instruction::And: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000637 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
638 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000639 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownZero);
640 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000641 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
642 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
643
644 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
645 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
646 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
647 KnownZero |= KnownZero2;
648 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000649 }
650 case Instruction::Or: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000651 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000652 APInt Mask2(Mask & ~KnownOne);
653 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000654 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
655 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
656
657 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
658 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
659 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
660 KnownOne |= KnownOne2;
661 return;
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000662 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000663 case Instruction::Xor: {
664 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
665 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
666 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
667 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
668
669 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
670 APInt KnownZeroOut = (KnownZero & KnownZero2) | (KnownOne & KnownOne2);
671 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
672 KnownOne = (KnownZero & KnownOne2) | (KnownOne & KnownZero2);
673 KnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
674 return;
675 }
676 case Instruction::Select:
677 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(2), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
678 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), Mask, KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1);
679 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
680 assert((KnownZero2 & KnownOne2) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
681
682 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
683 KnownOne &= KnownOne2;
684 KnownZero &= KnownZero2;
685 return;
686 case Instruction::FPTrunc:
687 case Instruction::FPExt:
688 case Instruction::FPToUI:
689 case Instruction::FPToSI:
690 case Instruction::SIToFP:
691 case Instruction::PtrToInt:
692 case Instruction::UIToFP:
693 case Instruction::IntToPtr:
694 return; // Can't work with floating point or pointers
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000695 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000696 // All these have integer operands
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000697 uint32_t SrcBitWidth =
698 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000699 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
700 MaskIn.zext(SrcBitWidth);
701 KnownZero.zext(SrcBitWidth);
702 KnownOne.zext(SrcBitWidth);
703 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000704 KnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
705 KnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000706 return;
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000707 }
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000708 case Instruction::BitCast: {
709 const Type *SrcTy = I->getOperand(0)->getType();
710 if (SrcTy->isInteger()) {
711 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
712 return;
713 }
714 break;
715 }
716 case Instruction::ZExt: {
717 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
718 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000719 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000720
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000721 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
722 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
723 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
724 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
725 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000726 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
727 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000728 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
729 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000730 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000731 return;
732 }
733 case Instruction::SExt: {
734 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
735 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000736 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000737
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000738 APInt MaskIn(Mask);
739 MaskIn.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
740 KnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
741 KnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
742 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), MaskIn, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000743 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng771dbf72007-03-13 02:23:10 +0000744 KnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
745 KnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000746
747 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
748 // top bits of the result.
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000749 if (KnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known zero
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000750 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000751 else if (KnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) // Input sign bit known set
Zhou Sheng34a4b382007-03-28 17:38:21 +0000752 KnownOne |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000753 return;
754 }
755 case Instruction::Shl:
756 // (shl X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (X & C2 >>u C1) == 0
757 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000758 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000759 APInt Mask2(Mask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
760 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000761 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Zhou Sheng430f6262007-03-12 05:44:52 +0000762 KnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
763 KnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000764 KnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt); // low bits known 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000765 return;
766 }
767 break;
768 case Instruction::LShr:
769 // (ushr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
770 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
771 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000772 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000773
774 // Unsigned shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000775 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
776 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000777 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
778 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
779 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000780 // high bits known zero.
781 KnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000782 return;
783 }
784 break;
785 case Instruction::AShr:
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000786 // (ashr X, C1) & C2 == 0 iff (-1 >> C1) & C2 == 0
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000787 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
788 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000789 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000790
791 // Signed shift right.
Reid Spencer2b812072007-03-25 02:03:12 +0000792 APInt Mask2(Mask.shl(ShiftAmt));
793 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2, KnownZero,KnownOne,Depth+1);
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000794 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
795 KnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(KnownZero, ShiftAmt);
796 KnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(KnownOne, ShiftAmt);
797
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000798 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
799 if (KnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known zero.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000800 KnownZero |= HighBits;
Zhou Shengaa305ab2007-03-28 02:19:03 +0000801 else if (KnownOne[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1]) // New bits are known one.
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000802 KnownOne |= HighBits;
Reid Spencer3e7594f2007-03-08 01:46:38 +0000803 return;
804 }
805 break;
806 }
807}
808
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000809/// MaskedValueIsZero - Return true if 'V & Mask' is known to be zero. We use
810/// this predicate to simplify operations downstream. Mask is known to be zero
811/// for bits that V cannot have.
812static bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt& Mask, unsigned Depth = 0) {
Zhou Shengedd089c2007-03-12 16:54:56 +0000813 APInt KnownZero(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0), KnownOne(Mask.getBitWidth(), 0);
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000814 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
815 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0 && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
816 return (KnownZero & Mask) == Mask;
817}
818
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000819/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
820/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
821/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
822/// constant and return true.
823static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000824 APInt Demanded) {
825 assert(I && "No instruction?");
826 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
827
828 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
829 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
830 if (!OpC) return false;
831
832 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
833 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
834 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
835 return false;
836
837 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
838 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
839 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
840 return true;
841}
842
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000843// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
844// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
845// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
846// min/max.
847static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000848 const APInt& KnownZero,
849 const APInt& KnownOne,
850 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
851 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
852 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
853 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
854 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
855 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000856 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000857
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000858 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
859 // bit if it is unknown.
860 Min = KnownOne;
861 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
862
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000863 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000864 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
865 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000866 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000867}
868
869// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
870// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
871// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
872// min/max.
873static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000874 const APInt &KnownZero,
875 const APInt &KnownOne,
876 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
877 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000878 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
879 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
880 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
881 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000882 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000883
884 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
885 Min = KnownOne;
886 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
887 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
888}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000889
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000890/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
891/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
892/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
893/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
894/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
895/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
896/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
897/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
898/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
899/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
900/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
901/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
902/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
903/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
904/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
905bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
906 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
907 unsigned Depth) {
908 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
909 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
910 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
911 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
912 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
913 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
914 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
915 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
916 must have same BitWidth");
917 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
918 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
919 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
920 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
921 return false;
922 }
923
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000924 KnownZero.clear();
925 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000926 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
927 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
928 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
929 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
930 return false;
931 }
932 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
933 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
934 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
935 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
936 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
937 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
938 return false;
939 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
940 return false;
941 }
942
943 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
944 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
945
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000946 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
947 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
948 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
949 default: break;
950 case Instruction::And:
951 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
952 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
953 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
954 return true;
955 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
956 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
957
958 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
959 // LHS.
960 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
961 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
962 return true;
963 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
964 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
965
966 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
967 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
968 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
969 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
970 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
971 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
972 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
973 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
974
975 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
976 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
977 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
978
979 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
980 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
981 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
982
983 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
984 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
985 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
986 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
987 break;
988 case Instruction::Or:
989 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
990 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
991 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
992 return true;
993 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
994 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
995 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
996 // LHS.
997 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
998 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
999 return true;
1000 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1001 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1002
1003 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1004 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
1005 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
1006 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
1007 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1008 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
1009 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
1010 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1011
1012 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
1013 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
1014 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
1015 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
1016 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1017 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
1018 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
1019 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1020
1021 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1022 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1023 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1024
1025 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
1026 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1027 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
1028 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
1029 break;
1030 case Instruction::Xor: {
1031 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1032 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1033 return true;
1034 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1035 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1036 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1037 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1038 return true;
1039 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1040 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1041
1042 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
1043 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
1044 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1045 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1046 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
1047 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
1048
1049 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1050 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1051 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1052 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1053 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1054 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1055
1056 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1057 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1058 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1059 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1060 Instruction *Or =
1061 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1062 I->getName());
1063 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1064 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1065 }
1066
1067 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1068 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1069 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1070 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1071 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1072 // all known
1073 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
1074 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
1075 Instruction *And =
1076 BinaryOperator::createAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
1077 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
1078 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
1079 }
1080 }
1081
1082 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1083 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
1084 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1085 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1086
1087 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1088 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1089 break;
1090 }
1091 case Instruction::Select:
1092 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
1093 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1094 return true;
1095 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
1096 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1097 return true;
1098 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1099 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1100 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1101 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1102
1103 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
1104 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
1105 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1106 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
1107 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1108
1109 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1110 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1111 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1112 break;
1113 case Instruction::Trunc: {
1114 uint32_t truncBf =
1115 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001116 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1117 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1118 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
1119 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1120 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001121 return true;
1122 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1123 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1124 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
1125 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1126 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1127 break;
1128 }
1129 case Instruction::BitCast:
1130 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
1131 return false;
1132
1133 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1134 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1135 return true;
1136 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1137 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1138 break;
1139 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1140 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1141 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001142 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001143
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001144 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1145 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1146 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001147 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1148 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 return true;
1150 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1151 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1152 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1153 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1154 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1155 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001156 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001157 break;
1158 }
1159 case Instruction::SExt: {
1160 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1161 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001162 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001163
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001165 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001167 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001168 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1169 // bit is demanded.
1170 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001171 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001172
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001173 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1174 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1175 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001176 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1177 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001178 return true;
1179 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1180 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1181 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1182 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1183 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1184
1185 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1186 // top bits of the result.
1187
1188 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1189 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001190 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001191 {
1192 // Convert to ZExt cast
1193 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1194 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001195 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001196 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001197 }
1198 break;
1199 }
1200 case Instruction::Add: {
1201 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1202 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1203 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001204 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001205
1206 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1207 // we can do.
1208 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1209 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1210 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1211 if (RHS->isZero())
1212 break;
1213
1214 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1215 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001216 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001217
1218 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1219 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1220 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1221 return true;
1222
1223 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1224 // the constant.
1225 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1226 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1227
1228 // Avoid excess work.
1229 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1230 break;
1231
1232 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1233 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1234 Instruction *Or =
1235 BinaryOperator::createOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
1236 I->getName());
1237 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1238 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1239 }
1240
1241 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1242 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1243 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1244 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1245 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1246
1247 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1248 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1249 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001250 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1251 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001252
1253 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1254
1255 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1256 // other, and there is no input carry.
1257 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1258 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1259
1260 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1261 // is no input carry.
1262 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1263 } else {
1264 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1265 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001266 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001267 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1268 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001269 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001270 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1271 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1272 return true;
1273 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1274 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1275 return true;
1276 }
1277 }
1278 break;
1279 }
1280 case Instruction::Sub:
1281 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1282 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001283 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001284 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1285 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001286 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001287 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001288 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1289 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1290 return true;
1291 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1292 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1293 return true;
1294 }
1295 break;
1296 case Instruction::Shl:
1297 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001298 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001299 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1300 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001301 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1302 return true;
1303 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1304 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1305 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1306 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1307 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001308 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001309 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001310 }
1311 break;
1312 case Instruction::LShr:
1313 // For a logical shift right
1314 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001315 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001316
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001317 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001318 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1319 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001320 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1321 return true;
1322 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1323 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001324 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1325 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001326 if (ShiftAmt) {
1327 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001328 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001329 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1330 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001331 }
1332 break;
1333 case Instruction::AShr:
1334 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1335 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1336 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1337 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1338 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1339 // Perform the logical shift right.
1340 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1341 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1342 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1343 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1344 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001345
1346 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1347 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1348 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1349 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001350
1351 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001352 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001353
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001354 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001355 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001356 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1357 // demanded.
1358 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1359 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001360 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001361 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001362 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1363 return true;
1364 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1365 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1366 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001367 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001368 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1369 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1370
1371 // Handle the sign bits.
1372 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1373 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1374 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1375
1376 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1377 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001378 if (RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001379 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1380 // Perform the logical shift right.
1381 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
1382 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1383 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1384 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1385 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1386 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1387 }
1388 }
1389 break;
1390 }
1391
1392 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1393 // constant.
1394 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1395 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1396 return false;
1397}
1398
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001399
1400/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value producecs a vector with
1401/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1402/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1403/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1404///
1405/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1406/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1407/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1408Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1409 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1410 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001411 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001412 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1413 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
1414 assert(DemandedElts != EltMask && (DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 &&
1415 "Invalid DemandedElts!");
1416
1417 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1418 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1419 UndefElts = EltMask;
1420 return 0;
1421 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1422 UndefElts = EltMask;
1423 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1424 }
1425
1426 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001427 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1428 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001429 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1430
1431 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1432 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1433 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1434 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1435 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1436 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1437 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1438 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1439 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1440 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1441 }
1442
1443 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001444 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001445 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1446 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001447 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001448 // set to undef.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001449 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001450 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1451 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1452 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1453 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1454 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1455 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001456 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001457 }
1458
1459 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
1460 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
1461 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1462 return false;
1463 }
1464 return false;
1465 } else if (Depth == 10) { // Limit search depth.
1466 return false;
1467 }
1468
1469 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1470 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1471
1472 bool MadeChange = false;
1473 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1474 Value *TmpV;
1475 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1476 default: break;
1477
1478 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1479 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1480 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001481 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001482 if (Idx == 0) {
1483 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1484 // which elt is getting updated.
1485 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1486 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1487 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1488 break;
1489 }
1490
1491 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1492 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001493 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001494 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1495 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1496
1497 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1498 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1499 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1500 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1501 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1502 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1503
1504 // The inserted element is defined.
1505 UndefElts |= 1ULL << IdxNo;
1506 break;
1507 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001508 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001509 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001510 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1511 if (!VTy) break;
1512 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1513 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1514 unsigned Ratio;
1515
1516 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001517 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001518 // elements as are demanded of us.
1519 Ratio = 1;
1520 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1521 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1522 // Untested so far.
1523 break;
1524
1525 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1526 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1527 // elements are live.
1528 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1529 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1530 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1531 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1532 }
1533 } else {
1534 // Untested so far.
1535 break;
1536
1537 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1538 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1539 // live.
1540 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1541 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1542 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1543 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1544 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001545
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001546 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1547 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1548 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1549 if (TmpV) {
1550 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1551 MadeChange = true;
1552 }
1553
1554 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1555 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1556 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1557 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1558 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1559 // undef.
1560 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1561 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1562 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1563 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1564 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1565 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1566 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1567 // elements are undef.
1568 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1569 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1570 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1571 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1572 }
1573 break;
1574 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001575 case Instruction::And:
1576 case Instruction::Or:
1577 case Instruction::Xor:
1578 case Instruction::Add:
1579 case Instruction::Sub:
1580 case Instruction::Mul:
1581 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1582 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1583 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1584 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1585 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1586 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1587 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1588
1589 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1590 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1591 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1592 break;
1593
1594 case Instruction::Call: {
1595 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1596 if (!II) break;
1597 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1598 default: break;
1599
1600 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1601 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1602 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1603 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1604 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1605 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1606 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1607 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1608 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1609 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1610 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1611 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1612 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1613 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1614 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1615 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1616
1617 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1618 // scalarize it now.
1619 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1620 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1621 default: break;
1622 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1623 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1624 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1625 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1626 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1627 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1628 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1629 // Extract the element as scalars.
1630 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1631 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1632
1633 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1634 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1635 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1636 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1637 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, RHS,
1638 II->getName()), *II);
1639 break;
1640 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1641 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1642 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, RHS,
1643 II->getName()), *II);
1644 break;
1645 }
1646
1647 Instruction *New =
1648 new InsertElementInst(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1649 II->getName());
1650 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1651 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1652 return New;
1653 }
1654 }
1655
1656 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1657 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1658 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1659 break;
1660 }
1661 break;
1662 }
1663 }
1664 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1665}
1666
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001667/// @returns true if the specified compare predicate is
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001668/// true when both operands are equal...
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001669/// @brief Determine if the icmp Predicate is true when both operands are equal
1670static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst::Predicate pred) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001671 return pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
1672 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
1673 pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
1674}
1675
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00001676/// @returns true if the specified compare instruction is
1677/// true when both operands are equal...
1678/// @brief Determine if the ICmpInst returns true when both operands are equal
1679static bool isTrueWhenEqual(ICmpInst &ICI) {
1680 return isTrueWhenEqual(ICI.getPredicate());
1681}
1682
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001683/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1684/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1685/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1686/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1687/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1688/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1689/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1690///
1691template<typename Functor>
1692Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
1693 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1694 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1695
1696 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1697 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1698 return F.apply(Root);
1699
1700 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1701 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001702 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001703 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1704 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1705
1706 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1707 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1708 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1709 ShouldApply = true;
1710 }
1711
1712 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1713 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1714 if (ShouldApply) {
1715 BasicBlock *BB = Root.getParent();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001716
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001717 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1718 // and perform the reassociation.
1719 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1720
1721 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1722 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1723
1724 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1725 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001726 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001727 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1728 return 0;
1729 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001730 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001731 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001732 TmpLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(TmpLHSI);
1733 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
1734 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, TmpLHSI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
1735 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001736
1737 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1738 // get to LHSI.
1739 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1740 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001741 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1742 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
1743 NextLHSI->getParent()->getInstList().remove(NextLHSI);
1744 BB->getInstList().insert(ARI, NextLHSI);
1745 ARI = NextLHSI;
1746
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001747 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1748 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1749 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1750 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1751 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001752
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001753 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1754 // the transformation...
1755 return F.apply(Root);
1756 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001757
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001758 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1759 }
1760 return 0;
1761}
1762
1763
1764// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
1765struct AddRHS {
1766 Value *RHS;
1767 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1768 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1769 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00001770 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00001771 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001772 }
1773};
1774
1775// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1776// iff C1&C2 == 0
1777struct AddMaskingAnd {
1778 Constant *C2;
1779 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1780 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001781 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001782 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001783 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001784 }
1785 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001786 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001787 }
1788};
1789
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001790static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001791 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001792 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001793 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001794 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), SOC, I.getType());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001795
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001796 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::create(
1797 CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), SO->getName() + ".cast"), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001798 }
1799
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001800 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001801 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1802 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001803
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001804 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1805 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001806 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1807 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001808 }
1809
1810 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1811 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1812 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1813 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001814 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1815 New = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001816 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1817 New = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
1818 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001819 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001820 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001821 abort();
1822 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001823 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1824}
1825
1826// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1827// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1828// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1829// not have a second operand.
1830static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1831 InstCombiner *IC) {
1832 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1833 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1834 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1835 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1836
1837 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001838 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001839 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001840
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001841 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1842 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1843
1844 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1845 SelectFalseVal);
1846 }
1847 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001848}
1849
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001850
1851/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1852/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1853/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1854Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1855 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001856 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001857 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001858
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001859 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1860 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001861 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001862 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1863 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1864 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1865 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001866 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001867 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1868
1869 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1870 // loop.
1871 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1872 return 0;
1873 }
1874
1875 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1876 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1877 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1878 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1879 if (NonConstBB) {
1880 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1881 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1882 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001883
1884 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001885 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001886 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001887 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001888 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001889
1890 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1891 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1892 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001893 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001894 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001895 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001896 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1897 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1898 else
1899 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001900 } else {
1901 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1902 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
1903 InV = BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(),
1904 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1905 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001906 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1907 InV = CmpInst::create(CI->getOpcode(),
1908 CI->getPredicate(),
1909 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1910 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001911 else
1912 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1913
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001914 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001915 }
1916 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001917 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001918 } else {
1919 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1920 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001921 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001922 Value *InV;
1923 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001924 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001925 } else {
1926 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001927 InV = CastInst::create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
1928 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1929 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001930 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001931 }
1932 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001933 }
1934 }
1935 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1936}
1937
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001938Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001939 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001940 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001941
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001942 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001943 // X + undef -> undef
1944 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1945 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1946
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001947 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001948 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001949 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1950 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001951 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
1952 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(-0.0))
1953 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001954 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001955
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001956 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001957 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001958 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001959 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001960 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00001961 return BinaryOperator::createXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001962
1963 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1964 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001965 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1966 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1967 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
1968 KnownZero, KnownOne))
1969 return &I;
1970 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001971 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001972
1973 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
1974 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
1975 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001976
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00001977 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
1978 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00001979 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
1980 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001981 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001982 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001983
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001984 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001985 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
1986 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001987 do {
1988 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001989 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
1990 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001991 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
1992 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001993 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00001994 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
1995 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001996 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001997 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00001998 }
1999 }
2000 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002001 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2002 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2003 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002004
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002005 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
2006 // with funny bit widths then this whole cascade of if statements should
2007 // be removed. It is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back
2008 // up to something that the back ends can handle.
2009 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2010 switch (Size) {
2011 default: break;
2012 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2013 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2014 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2015 }
2016 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002017 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002018 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002019 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002020 }
2021 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002022 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002023
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002024 // X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002025 if (I.getType()->isInteger() && I.getType() != Type::Int1Ty) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002026 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002027
2028 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2029 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2030 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2031 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2032 }
2033 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2034 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2035 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2036 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2037 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002038 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002039
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002040 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002041 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(LHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002042 return BinaryOperator::createSub(RHS, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002043
2044 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002045 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2046 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002047 return BinaryOperator::createSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002048
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002049
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002050 ConstantInt *C2;
2051 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2052 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
2053 return BinaryOperator::createMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
2054
2055 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2056 ConstantInt *C1;
2057 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002058 return BinaryOperator::createMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002059 }
2060
2061 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002062 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
2063 return BinaryOperator::createMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
2064
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002065 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002066 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2067 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002068
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002069
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002070 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002071 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002072 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2073 return R;
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002074
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002075 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002076 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002077 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
2078 return BinaryOperator::createSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002079
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002080 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2081 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002082 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002083 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2084 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2085 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002086 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002087
2088 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002089 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002090
2091 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002092 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002093
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002094 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2095 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
2096 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, CRHS,
2097 LHS->getName()), I);
2098 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewAdd, C2);
2099 }
2100 }
2101 }
2102
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002103 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2104 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002105 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002106 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002107 }
2108
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002109 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
2110 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) ->
2111 // intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002112 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002113 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2114 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002115 if (!CI) {
2116 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2117 Other = LHS;
2118 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002119 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002120 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2121 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002122 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002123 Value *I2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, CI->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002124 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty), I);
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002125 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new GetElementPtrInst(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002126 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002127 }
2128 }
2129
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002130 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002131}
2132
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002133// isSignBit - Return true if the value represented by the constant only has the
2134// highest order bit set.
2135static bool isSignBit(ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002136 uint32_t NumBits = CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer5a1e3e12007-03-19 20:58:18 +00002137 return CI->getValue() == APInt::getSignBit(NumBits);
Chris Lattner1ba5bcd2003-07-22 21:46:59 +00002138}
2139
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002140Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002141 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002142
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002143 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
2144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002145
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002146 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002147 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002148 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002149
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002150 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2151 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2152 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2153 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2154
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002155 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2156 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002157 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
2158 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002159
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002160 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002161 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002162 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002163 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(X, AddOne(C));
2164
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002165 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2166 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002167 if (C->isZero()) {
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002168 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1))
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002169 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002170 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002171 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002172 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002173 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002174 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002175 return BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr,
2176 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002177 }
2178 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002179 }
2180 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2181 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2182 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002183 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002184 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002185 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002186 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002187 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002188 }
2189 }
2190 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002191 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002192
2193 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2194 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002195 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002196 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002197
2198 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2199 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2200 return NV;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002201 }
2202
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002203 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2204 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002205 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002206 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002207 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002208 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002209 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002210 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2211 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2212 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002213 return BinaryOperator::createSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002214 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2215 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002216 }
2217
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002218 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002219 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2220 // is not used by anyone else...
2221 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002222 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002223 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002224 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2225 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2226 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2227 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002228
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002229 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002230 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002231 }
2232
2233 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2234 //
2235 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2236 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2237 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2238
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002239 Value *NewNot =
2240 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002241 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002242 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002243
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002244 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002245 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002246 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002247 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002248 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002249 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002250 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2251
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002252 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002253 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002254 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002255 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002256 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002257 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002258 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002259 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002260
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002261 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002262 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2263 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002264 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2265 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2266 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002268 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2269 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
2270 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002271 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002272
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002273 ConstantInt *C1;
2274 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002275 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
2276 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002277
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002278 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2279 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002280 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op1, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002281 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002282 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002283}
2284
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002285/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2286/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2287/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2288/// signed.
2289static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2290 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002291 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002292 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2293 TrueIfSigned = true;
2294 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002295 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2296 TrueIfSigned = true;
2297 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002298 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2299 TrueIfSigned = false;
2300 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002301 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2302 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2303 TrueIfSigned = true;
2304 return RHS->getValue() ==
2305 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2306 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2307 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2308 TrueIfSigned = true;
2309 return RHS->getValue() ==
2310 APInt::getSignBit(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002311 default:
2312 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002313 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002314}
2315
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002316Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002317 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002318 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002319
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002320 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2321 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2322
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002323 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002324 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2325 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002326
2327 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002328 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002329 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2330 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002331 return BinaryOperator::createMul(SI->getOperand(0),
2332 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002333
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002334 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002335 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2336 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2337 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2338 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Chris Lattner0af1fab2003-06-25 17:09:20 +00002339 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002340
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002341 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002342 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002343 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002344 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002345 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002346 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002347 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2348 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002349
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002350 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2351 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Dale Johannesen43421b32007-09-06 18:13:44 +00002352 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002353 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2354 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002355
2356 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2357 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
2358 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
2359 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
2360 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
2361 Op1, "tmp");
2362 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2363 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2364 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
2365 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Add, C1C2);
2366
2367 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002368
2369 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2370 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002371 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002372 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002373
2374 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2375 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2376 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002377 }
2378
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002379 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2380 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002381 return BinaryOperator::createMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002382
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002383 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2384 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2385 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2386 // formed.
2387 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002388 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002389 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002390 BoolCast = CI;
2391 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002392 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002393 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002394 BoolCast = CI;
2395 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002396 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002397 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2398 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002399 bool TIS = false;
2400
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002401 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002402 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2403 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002404 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2405 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002406 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002407 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002408 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002409 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002410 InsertNewInstBefore(
2411 BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002412 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2413 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002414
2415 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2416 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002417 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002418 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2419 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002420 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2421 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2422 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2423 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2424 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002425
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002426 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002427 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002428 }
2429 }
2430 }
2431
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002432 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002433}
2434
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002435/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2436/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2437/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2438/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002439Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002440 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002441
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002442 // undef / X -> 0
2443 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002444 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002445
2446 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002447 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002448 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002449
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002450 // Handle cases involving: div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002451 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2452 // div X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div X, Y. If the div and the select are in the
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002453 // same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the condition
2454 // of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same BB). If the
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002455 // select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be simplified
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002456 // also. Note that div X, Y is just as good as div X, 0 (undef)
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002457 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2458 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2459 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2460 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002461 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002462 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2463 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2464 else
2465 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
2466 return &I;
2467 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002468
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002469 // Likewise for: div X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div X, Y
2470 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2471 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2472 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2473 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002474 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002475 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2476 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2477 else
2478 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2479 return &I;
2480 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002481 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002482
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002483 return 0;
2484}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002485
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002486/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2487/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2488/// division instructions.
2489/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002490Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002491 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2492
2493 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2494 return Common;
2495
2496 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2497 // div X, 1 == X
2498 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2499 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2500
2501 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2502 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2503 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2504 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
2505 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002506 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002507 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002508
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002509 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002510 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2511 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2512 return R;
2513 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2514 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2515 return NV;
2516 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002517 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002518
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002519 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002520 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002521 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2522 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2523
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002524 return 0;
2525}
2526
2527Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2528 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2529
2530 // Handle the integer div common cases
2531 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2532 return Common;
2533
2534 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2535 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2536 // if so, convert to a right shift.
2537 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002538 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002539 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002540 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002541 }
2542
2543 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002544 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002545 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2546 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002547 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002548 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002549 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002550 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002551 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002552 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
2553 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002554 }
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00002555 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002556 }
2557 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002558 }
2559
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002560 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2561 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002562 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002563 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002564 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002565 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002566 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002567 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002568 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002569 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2570 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
2571 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2572 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2573 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2574
2575 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2576 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
2577 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::createLShr(
2578 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2579 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002580
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002581 // construct the select instruction and return it.
2582 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002583 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002584 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002585 return 0;
2586}
2587
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002588Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2589 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2590
2591 // Handle the integer div common cases
2592 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2593 return Common;
2594
2595 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2596 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2597 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
2598 return BinaryOperator::createNeg(Op0);
2599
2600 // -X/C -> X/-C
2601 if (Value *LHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op0))
2602 return BinaryOperator::createSDiv(LHSNeg, ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
2603 }
2604
2605 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2606 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002607 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002608 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002609 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2610 return BinaryOperator::createUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2611 }
2612 }
2613
2614 return 0;
2615}
2616
2617Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2618 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2619}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002620
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002621/// GetFactor - If we can prove that the specified value is at least a multiple
2622/// of some factor, return that factor.
2623static Constant *GetFactor(Value *V) {
2624 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
2625 return CI;
2626
2627 // Unless we can be tricky, we know this is a multiple of 1.
2628 Constant *Result = ConstantInt::get(V->getType(), 1);
2629
2630 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
2631 if (!I) return Result;
2632
2633 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
2634 // Handle multiplies by a constant, etc.
2635 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)),
2636 GetFactor(I->getOperand(1)));
2637 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
2638 // (X<<C) -> X * (1 << C)
2639 if (Constant *ShRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2640 ShRHS = ConstantExpr::getShl(Result, ShRHS);
2641 return ConstantExpr::getMul(GetFactor(I->getOperand(0)), ShRHS);
2642 }
2643 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
2644 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
2645 // X & 0xFFF0 is known to be a multiple of 16.
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00002646 uint32_t Zeros = RHS->getValue().countTrailingZeros();
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002647 if (Zeros != V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
2648 return ConstantExpr::getShl(Result,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002649 ConstantInt::get(Result->getType(), Zeros));
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002650 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002651 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002652 // Only handle int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002653 if (!CI->isIntegerCast())
2654 return Result;
2655 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
2656 return ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), GetFactor(Op), V->getType());
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002657 }
2658 return Result;
2659}
2660
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002661/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2662/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2663/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2664/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2665Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002666 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002667
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002668 // 0 % X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
2669 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2670 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2671 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2672
2673 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) // undef % X -> 0
2674 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2675 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2676 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002677
2678 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2679 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2680 // rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> rem X, Y. If the rem and the select are in
2681 // the same basic block, then we replace the select with Y, and the
2682 // condition of the select with false (if the cond value is in the same
2683 // BB). If the select has uses other than the div, this allows them to be
2684 // simplified also.
2685 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2686 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2687 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2688 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002689 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002690 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2691 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(2));
2692 else
2693 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002694 return &I;
2695 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002696 // Likewise for: rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> rem X, Y
2697 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2698 if (ST->isNullValue()) {
2699 Instruction *CondI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(SI->getOperand(0));
2700 if (CondI && CondI->getParent() == I.getParent())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002701 UpdateValueUsesWith(CondI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002702 else if (I.getParent() != SI->getParent() || SI->hasOneUse())
2703 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(1));
2704 else
2705 UpdateValueUsesWith(SI, SI->getOperand(1));
2706 return &I;
2707 }
Chris Lattner11a49f22005-11-05 07:28:37 +00002708 }
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002709
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002710 return 0;
2711}
2712
2713/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2714/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2715/// remainder instructions.
2716/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2717Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2718 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2719
2720 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2721 return common;
2722
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002723 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002724 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2725 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2726 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2727
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002728 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2729 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2730
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002731 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2732 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2733 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2734 return R;
2735 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
2736 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2737 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002738 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002739 // (X * C1) % C2 --> 0 iff C1 % C2 == 0
2740 if (ConstantExpr::getSRem(GetFactor(Op0I), RHS)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerdb3f8732006-03-02 06:50:58 +00002741 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002742 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002743 }
2744
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002745 return 0;
2746}
2747
2748Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2749 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2750
2751 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2752 return common;
2753
2754 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2755 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
2756 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
2757 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
2758 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002759 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002760 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
2761 }
2762
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002763 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002764 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
2765 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2766 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002767 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002768 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
2769 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(RHSI, N1,
2770 "tmp"), I);
2771 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, Add);
2772 }
2773 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002774 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002775
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002776 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
2777 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
2778 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
2779 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2780 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
2781 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002782 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
2783 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002784 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2785 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
2786 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
2787 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
2788 return new SelectInst(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
2789 }
2790 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002791 }
2792
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002793 return 0;
2794}
2795
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002796Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
2797 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2798
2799 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
2800 return common;
2801
2802 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
2803 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) ||
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002804 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002805 // X % -Y -> X % Y
2806 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
2807 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
2808 return &I;
2809 }
2810
2811 // If the top bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2812 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002813 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002814 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
2815 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
2816 return BinaryOperator::createURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
2817 }
2818
2819 return 0;
2820}
2821
2822Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002823 return commonRemTransforms(I);
2824}
2825
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002826// isMaxValueMinusOne - return true if this is Max-1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002827static bool isMaxValueMinusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Reid Spencer3a2a9fb2007-03-19 21:10:28 +00002828 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002829 if (!isSigned)
2830 return C->getValue() == APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits) - 1;
2831 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(TypeBits)-1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002832}
2833
2834// isMinValuePlusOne - return true if this is Min+1
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002835static bool isMinValuePlusOne(const ConstantInt *C, bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002836 if (!isSigned)
2837 return C->getValue() == 1; // unsigned
2838
2839 // Calculate 1111111111000000000000
2840 uint32_t TypeBits = C->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2841 return C->getValue() == APInt::getSignedMinValue(TypeBits)+1;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00002842}
2843
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002844// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
2845// constant.
2846static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00002847 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00002848}
2849
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002850// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
2851// This is the same as lowones(~X).
2852static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00002853 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00002854}
2855
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002856/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002857/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
2858///
2859/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
2860///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002861/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
2862/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002863///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002864/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
2865/// 0 A > B
2866/// 1 A == B
2867/// 2 A < B
2868///
2869/// <=> Value Definition
2870/// 000 0 Always false
2871/// 001 1 A > B
2872/// 010 2 A == B
2873/// 011 3 A >= B
2874/// 100 4 A < B
2875/// 101 5 A != B
2876/// 110 6 A <= B
2877/// 111 7 Always true
2878///
2879static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
2880 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002881 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
2883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
2884 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
2885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
2886 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
2887 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
2888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
2889 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
2890 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
2891 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002892 // True -> 7
2893 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002894 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002895 return 0;
2896 }
2897}
2898
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002899/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
2900/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
2901/// new /// ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
2902/// of predicate to use in new icmp instructions.
2903static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2904 switch (code) {
2905 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002906 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002907 case 1:
2908 if (sign)
2909 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
2910 else
2911 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
2912 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
2913 case 3:
2914 if (sign)
2915 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
2916 else
2917 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
2918 case 4:
2919 if (sign)
2920 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
2921 else
2922 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
2923 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
2924 case 6:
2925 if (sign)
2926 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
2927 else
2928 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002929 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002930 }
2931}
2932
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002933static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
2934 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
2935 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) &&
2936 (p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p2 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)) ||
2937 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) &&
2938 (p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || p1 == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
2939}
2940
2941namespace {
2942// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
2943struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002944 InstCombiner &IC;
2945 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002946 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
2947 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
2948 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
2949 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002950 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002951 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
2952 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
2953 return (ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS ||
2954 ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002955 return false;
2956 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002957 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
2958 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
2959 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
2960 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
2961 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002962 }
2963
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002964 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002965 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002966 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002967 unsigned Code;
2968 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
2969 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
2970 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
2971 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00002972 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002973 }
2974
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00002975 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
2976 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
2977
2978 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002979 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
2980 return I;
2981 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
2982 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
2983 }
2984};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00002985} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00002986
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002987// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
2988// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002989// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002990Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00002991 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
2992 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002993 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
2994 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00002995 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002996 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002997 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00002998
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00002999 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3000 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003001 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003002 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003003 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003004 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003005 And->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003006 return BinaryOperator::createXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003007 }
3008 break;
3009 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003010 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3011 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003012
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003013 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3014 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003015 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003016 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003017 Or->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003018 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003019 }
3020 break;
3021 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003022 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003023 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3024 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3025 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003026 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003027
3028 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003029 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003030 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3031 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3032 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003033 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003034
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003035 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3036 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3037 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3038 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3039 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3040 // no effect.
3041 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3042 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3043 return &TheAnd;
3044 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003045 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003046 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003047 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003048 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003049 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003050 }
3051 }
3052 }
3053 }
3054 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003055
3056 case Instruction::Shl: {
3057 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3058 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3059 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003060 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003061 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003062 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3063 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003064
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003065 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3066 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003067 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3068 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003069 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3070 return &TheAnd;
3071 }
3072 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003073 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003074 case Instruction::LShr:
3075 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003076 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3077 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3078 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3079 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003080 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003081 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003082 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3083 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003084
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003085 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3086 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003087 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3088 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3089 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3090 return &TheAnd;
3091 }
3092 break;
3093 }
3094 case Instruction::AShr:
3095 // Signed shr.
3096 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3097 // with an and.
3098 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003099 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003100 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003101 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3102 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003103 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003104 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003105 // Make the argument unsigned.
3106 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003107 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00003108 BinaryOperator::createLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003109 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003110 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003111 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003112 }
3113 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003114 }
3115 return 0;
3116}
3117
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003118
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003119/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3120/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003121/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3122/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003123/// insert new instructions.
3124Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003125 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3126 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003127 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003128 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003129 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003130
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003131 if (Inside) {
3132 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003133 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003134
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003135 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003136 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003137 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003138 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3139 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3140 }
3141
3142 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3143 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
3144 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003145 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003146 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3147 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003148 }
3149
3150 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003151 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003152
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003153 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003154 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003155 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003156 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3157 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3158 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3159 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003160
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003161 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3162 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3163 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003164 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003165 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003166 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3167 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003168}
3169
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003170// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3171// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3172// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3173// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003174static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003175 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003176 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3177 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003178
3179 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003180 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003181 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003182 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003183 return true;
3184}
3185
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003186/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3187/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3188/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003189///
3190/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3191/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3192/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3193///
3194/// return (A +/- B).
3195///
3196Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003197 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003198 Instruction &I) {
3199 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3200 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3201 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3202
3203 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3204
3205 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3206 default: return 0;
3207 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003208 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003209 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003210 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3211 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3212 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003213 break;
3214
3215 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3216 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3217 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003218 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003219 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003220 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003221 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003222 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003223 break;
3224 }
3225 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003226 return 0;
3227 case Instruction::Or:
3228 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003229 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003230 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3231 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003232 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003233 break;
3234 return 0;
3235 }
3236
3237 Instruction *New;
3238 if (isSub)
3239 New = BinaryOperator::createSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3240 else
3241 New = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
3242 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3243}
3244
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003245Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003246 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003247 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003248
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003249 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3250 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3251
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003252 // and X, X = X
3253 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003254 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003255
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003256 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003257 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003258 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003259 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3260 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3261 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003262 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003263 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003264 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003265 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003266 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003267 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003268 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3269 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003270 }
3271 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003272
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003273 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003274 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3275 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003276
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003277 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003278 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003279 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003280 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3281 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3282 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3283 case Instruction::Xor:
3284 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003285 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3286 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3287 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3288 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
3289 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
3290 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3291 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
3292 return BinaryOperator::create(
3293 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003294 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003295 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003296 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3297 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
3298 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
3299 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3300 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
3301 return BinaryOperator::create(
3302 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3303 }
3304 }
3305
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003306 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003307 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003308 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3309 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3310 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3311 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3312 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
3313 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
3314 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003315 break;
3316
3317 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003318 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3319 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3320 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3321 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
3322 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003323 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003324 }
3325
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003326 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003327 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003328 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003329 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003330 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3331 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3332 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3333 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003334 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003335 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner7560c3a2006-02-08 07:34:50 +00003336 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003337 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3338 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003339 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3340 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3341 // other simplifications.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003342 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::createTruncOrBitCast(
3343 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3344 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003345 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003346 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003347 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003348 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003349 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewCast, C3);
3350 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3351 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3352 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003353 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003354 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3356 }
3357 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003358 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003359
3360 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3361 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003362 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003363 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003364 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3365 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3366 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003367 }
3368
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003369 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3370 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003371
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003372 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3373 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3374
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003375 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003376 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003377 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
3378 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003379 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003380 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Or);
3381 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003382
3383 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003384 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3385 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003386 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3387 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003388
3389 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3390 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3391 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3392 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3393 }
3394 }
3395
3396 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003397 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3398 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003399
3400 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3401 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3402 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
3403 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
3404 }
3405 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003406
3407 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3408 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3409 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3410 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3411 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3412 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3413 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3414 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3415 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3416 }
3417 }
3418 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3419 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3420 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3421 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3422 std::swap(A, B);
3423 }
3424 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
3425 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::createNot(B, "tmp");
3426 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
3427 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
3428 }
3429 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003430 }
3431
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003432 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
3433 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3434 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003435 return R;
3436
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003437 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3438 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003439 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3440 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3441 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3442 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) & (X icmp C2)
3443 // ICMP_[GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[GL]T elsewhere.
3444 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3445 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3446 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3447 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003448 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003449 ICmpInst::Predicate GT = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ?
3450 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
3451 Constant *Cmp = ConstantExpr::getICmp(GT, LHSCst, RHSCst);
3452 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003453 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Cmp)->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003454 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3455 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3456 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3457 }
3458
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003459 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003460 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3461 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003462 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3463 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3464 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003465 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3466
3467 switch (LHSCC) {
3468 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003469 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003470 switch (RHSCC) {
3471 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003472 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3473 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3474 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003475 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003476 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3477 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3478 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003479 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3480 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003481 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003482 switch (RHSCC) {
3483 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003484 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3485 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3486 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3487 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3488 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3489 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3490 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSVal, LHSCst);
3491 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3492 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3493 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3494 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003495 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003496 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3497 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003498 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3499 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3500 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3501 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Chris Lattner424db022007-01-27 23:08:34 +00003502 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3503 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003504 }
3505 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3506 }
3507 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003508 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003509 switch (RHSCC) {
3510 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003511 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3512 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003513 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003514 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3515 break;
3516 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3517 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003518 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003519 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3520 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003521 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003522 break;
3523 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003524 switch (RHSCC) {
3525 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003526 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3527 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003528 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003529 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3530 break;
3531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3532 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003533 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003534 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3535 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003536 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003537 break;
3538 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3539 switch (RHSCC) {
3540 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3541 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X > 13
3542 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3543 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3545 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3546 break;
3547 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3548 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3549 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3550 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3551 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) ->(X-14) <u 1
3552 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false,
3553 true, I);
3554 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3555 break;
3556 }
3557 break;
3558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3559 switch (RHSCC) {
3560 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3561 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X s> 13
3562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3563 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3564 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3565 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3566 break;
3567 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3568 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3569 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, LHSVal, RHSCst);
3570 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3571 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) ->(X-14) s< 1
3572 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true,
3573 true, I);
3574 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3575 break;
3576 }
3577 break;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00003578 }
3579 }
3580 }
3581
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003582 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003583 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
3584 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
3585 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
3586 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003587 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003588 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003589 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
3590 I.getType(), TD) &&
3591 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
3592 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00003593 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
3594 Op1C->getOperand(0),
3595 I.getName());
3596 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
3597 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
3598 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003599 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003600
3601 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003602 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3603 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3604 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003605 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3606 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3607 Instruction *NewOp =
3608 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
3609 SI1->getOperand(0),
3610 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003611 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3612 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003613 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00003614 }
3615
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003616 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003617}
3618
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003619/// CollectBSwapParts - Look to see if the specified value defines a single byte
3620/// in the result. If it does, and if the specified byte hasn't been filled in
3621/// yet, fill it in and return false.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003622static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003623 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
3624 if (I == 0) return true;
3625
3626 // If this is an or instruction, it is an inner node of the bswap.
3627 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or)
3628 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3629 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), ByteValues);
3630
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003631 uint32_t BitWidth = I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003632 // If this is a shift by a constant int, and it is "24", then its operand
3633 // defines a byte. We only handle unsigned types here.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003634 if (I->isShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003635 // Not shifting the entire input by N-1 bytes?
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003636 if (cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) !=
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003637 8*(ByteValues.size()-1))
3638 return true;
3639
3640 unsigned DestNo;
3641 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
3642 // X << 24 defines the top byte with the lowest of the input bytes.
3643 DestNo = ByteValues.size()-1;
3644 } else {
3645 // X >>u 24 defines the low byte with the highest of the input bytes.
3646 DestNo = 0;
3647 }
3648
3649 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3650 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3651 if (ByteValues[DestNo] && ByteValues[DestNo] != I->getOperand(0))
3652 return true;
3653 ByteValues[DestNo] = I->getOperand(0);
3654 return false;
3655 }
3656
3657 // Otherwise, we can only handle and(shift X, imm), imm). Bail out of if we
3658 // don't have this.
3659 Value *Shift = 0, *ShiftLHS = 0;
3660 ConstantInt *AndAmt = 0, *ShiftAmt = 0;
3661 if (!match(I, m_And(m_Value(Shift), m_ConstantInt(AndAmt))) ||
3662 !match(Shift, m_Shift(m_Value(ShiftLHS), m_ConstantInt(ShiftAmt))))
3663 return true;
3664 Instruction *SI = cast<Instruction>(Shift);
3665
3666 // Make sure that the shift amount is by a multiple of 8 and isn't too big.
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003667 if (ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) & 7 ||
3668 ShiftAmt->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) > 8*ByteValues.size())
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003669 return true;
3670
3671 // Turn 0xFF -> 0, 0xFF00 -> 1, 0xFF0000 -> 2, etc.
3672 unsigned DestByte;
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003673 if (AndAmt->getValue().getActiveBits() > 64)
3674 return true;
3675 uint64_t AndAmtVal = AndAmt->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003676 for (DestByte = 0; DestByte != ByteValues.size(); ++DestByte)
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003677 if (AndAmtVal == uint64_t(0xFF) << 8*DestByte)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003678 break;
3679 // Unknown mask for bswap.
3680 if (DestByte == ByteValues.size()) return true;
3681
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003682 unsigned ShiftBytes = ShiftAmt->getZExtValue()/8;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003683 unsigned SrcByte;
3684 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
3685 SrcByte = DestByte - ShiftBytes;
3686 else
3687 SrcByte = DestByte + ShiftBytes;
3688
3689 // If the SrcByte isn't a bswapped value from the DestByte, reject it.
3690 if (SrcByte != ByteValues.size()-DestByte-1)
3691 return true;
3692
3693 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
3694 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
3695 if (ByteValues[DestByte] && ByteValues[DestByte] != SI->getOperand(0))
3696 return true;
3697 ByteValues[DestByte] = SI->getOperand(0);
3698 return false;
3699}
3700
3701/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
3702/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
3703Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003704 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
3705 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16)
3706 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003707
3708 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
3709 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00003710 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00003711 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003712
3713 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
3714 if (CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(0), ByteValues) ||
3715 CollectBSwapParts(I.getOperand(1), ByteValues))
3716 return 0;
3717
3718 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
3719 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
3720 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
3721
3722 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
3723 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
3724 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
3725 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003726 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003727 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00003728 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003729 return new CallInst(F, V);
3730}
3731
3732
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003733Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003734 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003735 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003736
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003737 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003738 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003739
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003740 // or X, X = X
3741 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003743
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003744 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
3745 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003746 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
3747 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3748 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3749 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3750 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3751 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003752 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
3754 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3755 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
3756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00003757 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003758
3759
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003760
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003761 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003762 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003763 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003764 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
3765 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003766 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003767 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003768 Or->takeName(Op0);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003769 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Or,
3770 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003771 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003772
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003773 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
3774 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003775 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::createOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003776 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003777 Or->takeName(Op0);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003778 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003779 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003780 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003781
3782 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3783 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003784 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003785 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003786 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3787 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3788 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00003789 }
3790
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00003791 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
3792 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003793
3794 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3795 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
3796 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
3797 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
3798 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
3799 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3800
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003801 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
3802 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003803 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00003804 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
3805 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
3806 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00003807 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
3808 return BSwap;
3809 }
3810
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003811 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3812 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003813 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003814 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op1);
3815 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3816 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3817 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003818 }
3819
3820 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
3821 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003822 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003823 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::createOr(A, Op0);
3824 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
3825 NOr->takeName(Op0);
3826 return BinaryOperator::createXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00003827 }
3828
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003829 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00003830 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003831 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
3832 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003833 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
3834 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
3835 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
3836 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
3837 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
3838 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
3839 // replace with V+N.
3840 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
3841 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
3842 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3843 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3844 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
3845 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3846 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
3847 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
3848 }
3849 // Or commutes, try both ways.
3850 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
3851 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
3852 // Add commutes, try both ways.
3853 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
3854 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3855 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
3856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
3857 }
3858 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00003859 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00003860 }
3861
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003862 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
3863 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003864 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3865 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
3866 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
3867 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
3868 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
3869 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
3870 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
3871 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
3872 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
3873
3874 if (V1) {
3875 Value *Or =
3876 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
3877 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00003878 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00003879 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00003880 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003881
3882 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003883 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
3884 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
3885 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003886 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
3887 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
3888 Instruction *NewOp =
3889 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
3890 SI1->getOperand(0),
3891 SI0->getName()), I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003892 return BinaryOperator::create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
3893 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00003894 }
3895 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00003896
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003897 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
3898 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003899 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003900 } else {
3901 A = 0;
3902 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00003903 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003904 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
3905 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00003906 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003907
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003908 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00003909 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
3910 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, B,
3911 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
3912 return BinaryOperator::createNot(And);
3913 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00003914 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003915
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003916 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3917 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
3918 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003919 return R;
3920
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003921 Value *LHSVal, *RHSVal;
3922 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003923 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3924 if (match(Op0, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(LHSVal), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))))
3925 if (match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(RHSVal), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
3926 if (LHSVal == RHSVal && // Found (X icmp C1) | (X icmp C2)
3927 // icmp [us][gl]e x, cst is folded to icmp [us][gl]t elsewhere.
3928 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3929 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE &&
3930 LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && LHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003931 RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE && RHSCC != ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE &&
3932 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
3933 PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003934 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003935 ICmpInst *LHS = cast<ICmpInst>(Op0);
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003936 bool NeedsSwap;
3937 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC))
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003938 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003939 else
Chris Lattner3aea1bd2007-05-11 16:58:45 +00003940 NeedsSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner88858872007-05-11 05:55:56 +00003941
3942 if (NeedsSwap) {
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003943 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3944 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3945 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3946 }
3947
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003948 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003949 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
3950 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003951 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
3952 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003953 // equal.
3954 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3955
3956 switch (LHSCC) {
3957 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003958 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003959 switch (RHSCC) {
3960 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003961 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003962 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
3963 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3964 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::createAdd(LHSVal, AddCST,
3965 LHSVal->getName()+".off");
3966 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00003967 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003968 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003969 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003970 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
3971 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
3972 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
Chris Lattner240d6f42005-04-19 06:04:18 +00003973 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003974 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
3975 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
3976 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003977 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3978 }
3979 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003980 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003981 switch (RHSCC) {
3982 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003983 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
3984 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
3985 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003986 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003987 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
3988 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
3989 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003991 }
3992 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003993 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003994 switch (RHSCC) {
3995 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003996 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00003997 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003998 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) ->(X-13) u> 2
3999 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false,
4000 false, I);
4001 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4002 break;
4003 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4004 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004006 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4007 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004008 }
4009 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004010 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004011 switch (RHSCC) {
4012 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004013 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4014 break;
4015 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) ->(X-13) s> 2
4016 return InsertRangeTest(LHSVal, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true,
4017 false, I);
4018 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4019 break;
4020 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4021 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4022 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4023 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4024 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004025 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004026 break;
4027 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4028 switch (RHSCC) {
4029 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4030 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4031 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4032 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4033 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4034 break;
4035 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4036 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004037 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004038 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4039 break;
4040 }
4041 break;
4042 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4043 switch (RHSCC) {
4044 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4045 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4046 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4047 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4048 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4049 break;
4050 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4051 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004052 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004053 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4054 break;
4055 }
4056 break;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004057 }
4058 }
4059 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004060
4061 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004062 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004063 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004064 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
4065 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004066 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004067 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004068 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4069 I.getType(), TD) &&
4070 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4071 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004072 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4073 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4074 I.getName());
4075 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4076 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4077 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004078 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004079
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004080
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004081 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004082}
4083
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004084// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4085struct XorSelf {
4086 Value *RHS;
4087 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4088 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4089 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4090 return &Xor;
4091 }
4092};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004093
4094
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004095Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004096 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004097 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004098
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004099 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
4100 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
4101
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004102 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4103 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004104 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004105 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004106 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004107
4108 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4109 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004110 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4111 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4112 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4113 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4114 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4115 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004116 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4117 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004118 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004119
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004120 // Is this a ~ operation?
4121 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4122 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4123 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4124 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4125 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4126 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4127 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4128 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4129 Instruction *NotY =
4130 BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
4131 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4132 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4133 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
4134 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4135 else
4136 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
4137 }
4138 }
4139 }
4140 }
4141
4142
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004143 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004144 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
4145 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
4146 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004147 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4148 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004149
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004150 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4151 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4152 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4153 }
4154
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004155 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004156 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004157 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4158 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004159 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4160 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004161 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004162 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004163 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004164
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004165 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004166 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004167 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004168 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004169 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
4170 return BinaryOperator::createSub(
4171 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004172 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004173 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004174 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004175 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4176 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
4177 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004178
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004179 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004180 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4181 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004182 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004183 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4184 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4185 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004186 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004187 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4188 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004189 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004190 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4191 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4192 return &I;
4193 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004194 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004195 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004196
4197 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4198 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004199 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004200 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004201 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4202 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4203 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004204 }
4205
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004206 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004207 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004208 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004209
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004210 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004211 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004212 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004213
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004214
4215 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4216 if (Op1I) {
4217 Value *A, *B;
4218 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4219 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004220 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004221 I.swapOperands();
4222 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004223 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004224 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004225 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004226 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004227 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4228 if (Op0 == A) // A^(A^B) == B
4229 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4230 else if (Op0 == B) // A^(B^A) == B
4231 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4232 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004233 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004234 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004235 std::swap(A, B);
4236 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004237 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004238 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4239 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4240 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004241 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004242 }
4243
4244 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4245 if (Op0I) {
4246 Value *A, *B;
4247 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4248 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4249 std::swap(A, B);
4250 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
4251 Instruction *NotB =
4252 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
4253 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004254 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004255 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4256 if (Op1 == A) // (A^B)^A == B
4257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4258 else if (Op1 == B) // (B^A)^A == B
4259 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4260 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
4261 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
4262 std::swap(A, B);
4263 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00004264 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004265 Instruction *N =
4266 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(A, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004267 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(N, Op1);
4268 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004269 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004270 }
4271
4272 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
4273 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
4274 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
4275 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
4276 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
4277 Instruction *NewOp =
4278 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
4279 Op1I->getOperand(0),
4280 Op0I->getName()), I);
4281 return BinaryOperator::create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
4282 Op1I->getOperand(1));
4283 }
4284
4285 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
4286 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
4287 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
4288 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4289 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4290 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4291 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4292 }
4293 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
4294 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4295 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4296 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
4297 return BinaryOperator::createXor(A, B);
4298 }
4299
4300 // (A & B)^(C & D)
4301 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
4302 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
4303 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
4304 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
4305 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
4306 if (A == C)
4307 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
4308 else if (A == D)
4309 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
4310 else if (B == C)
4311 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
4312 else if (B == D)
4313 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
4314
4315 if (X) {
4316 Instruction *NewOp =
4317 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
4318 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NewOp, X);
4319 }
4320 }
4321 }
4322
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004323 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4324 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4325 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004326 return R;
4327
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004328 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004329 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004330 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004331 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
4332 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004333 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004334 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004335 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4336 I.getType(), TD) &&
4337 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4338 I.getType(), TD)) {
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004339 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
4340 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4341 I.getName());
4342 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
4343 return CastInst::create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
4344 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004345 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004346
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004347 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004348}
4349
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004350/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
4351/// overflowed for this type.
4352static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004353 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004354 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004355
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00004356 if (IsSigned)
4357 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
4358 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
4359 else
4360 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
4361 else
4362 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004363}
4364
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004365/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
4366/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
4367/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
4368static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
4369 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
4370 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004371 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
4372 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004373
4374 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004375 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSize()*8;
4376 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004377
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004378 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
4379 Value *Op = GEP->getOperand(i);
Chris Lattner0b84c802005-01-13 23:26:48 +00004380 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004381 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
4382 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
4383
4384 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
4385 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
4386 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
4387
4388 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
4389 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004390 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004391 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4392 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result,
4393 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
4394 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
4395 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004396 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004397
4398 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4399 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
4400 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
4401 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
4402 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
4403 else {
4404 // Emit an add instruction.
4405 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
4406 BinaryOperator::createAdd(Result, Scale,
4407 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00004408 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004409 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004410 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00004411 // Convert to correct type.
4412 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
4413 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4414 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
4415 else
4416 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
4417 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
4418 }
4419 if (Size != 1) {
4420 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
4421 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
4422 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
4423 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
4424 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createMul(Op, Scale,
4425 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
4426 }
4427
4428 // Emit an add instruction.
4429 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
4430 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
4431 cast<Constant>(Result));
4432 else
4433 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAdd(Op, Result,
4434 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004435 }
4436 return Result;
4437}
4438
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004439/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004440/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004441Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
4442 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
4443 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004444 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004445
4446 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS))
4447 if (isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
4448 RHS = CI->getOperand(0);
4449
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004450 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
4451 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
4452 // As an optimization, we don't actually have to compute the actual value of
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004453 // OFFSET if this is a icmp_eq or icmp_ne comparison, just return whether
4454 // each index is zero or not.
4455 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ || Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004456 Instruction *InVal = 0;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004457 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEPLHS);
4458 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004459 bool EmitIt = true;
4460 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))) {
4461 if (isa<UndefValue>(C)) // undef index -> undef.
4462 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
4463 if (C->isNullValue())
4464 EmitIt = false;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +00004465 else if (TD->getTypeSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) == 0) {
4466 EmitIt = false; // This is indexing into a zero sized array?
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004467 } else if (isa<ConstantInt>(C))
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004468 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004469 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4470 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004471 }
4472
4473 if (EmitIt) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004474 Instruction *Comp =
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004475 new ICmpInst(Cond, GEPLHS->getOperand(i),
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004476 Constant::getNullValue(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()));
4477 if (InVal == 0)
4478 InVal = Comp;
4479 else {
4480 InVal = InsertNewInstBefore(InVal, I);
4481 InsertNewInstBefore(Comp, I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004482 if (Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE) // True if any are unequal
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004483 InVal = BinaryOperator::createOr(InVal, Comp);
4484 else // True if all are equal
4485 InVal = BinaryOperator::createAnd(InVal, Comp);
4486 }
4487 }
4488 }
4489
4490 if (InVal)
4491 return InVal;
4492 else
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004493 // No comparison is needed here, all indexes = 0
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004494 ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4495 Cond == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ));
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004496 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004497
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004498 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004499 // the result to fold to a constant!
4500 if (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) {
4501 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
4502 Value *Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004503 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
4504 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004505 }
4506 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004507 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
4508 // compare the base pointer.
4509 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
4510 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00004511 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00004512 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004513 if (IndicesTheSame)
4514 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4515 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
4516 IndicesTheSame = false;
4517 break;
4518 }
4519
4520 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
4521 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004522 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
4523 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004524
4525 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
4526 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004527 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00004528 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004529
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004530 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
4531 bool AllZeros = true;
4532 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4533 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4534 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4535 AllZeros = false;
4536 break;
4537 }
4538 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004539 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
4540 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004541
4542 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004543 AllZeros = true;
4544 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4545 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
4546 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4547 AllZeros = false;
4548 break;
4549 }
4550 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004551 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00004552
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004553 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
4554 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
4555 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
4556 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
4557 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4558 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00004559 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
4560 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004561 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004562 NumDifferences = 2;
4563 break;
4564 } else {
4565 if (NumDifferences++) break;
4566 DiffOperand = i;
4567 }
4568 }
4569
4570 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
4571 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00004572 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4573 isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
4574
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004575 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00004576 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
4577 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004578 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
4579 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00004580 }
4581 }
4582
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004583 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004584 // the result to fold to a constant!
4585 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
4586 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
4587 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
4588 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
4589 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004590 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004591 }
4592 }
4593 return 0;
4594}
4595
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004596Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
4597 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004598 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004599
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00004600 // Fold trivial predicates.
4601 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4602 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int1Ty));
4603 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4604 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4605
4606 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
4607 if (Op0 == Op1) {
4608 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4609 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
4610 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
4611 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
4612 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
4613 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 1));
4614 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
4615 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
4616 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
4617 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, 0));
4618
4619 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
4620 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
4621 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
4622 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
4623 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
4624 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
4625 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4626 return &I;
4627
4628 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
4629 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
4630 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
4631 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
4632 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
4633 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
4634 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
4635 return &I;
4636 }
4637 }
4638
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004639 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004640 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004641
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004642 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
4643 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4644 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4645 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
4646 case Instruction::PHI:
4647 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4648 return NV;
4649 break;
4650 case Instruction::Select:
4651 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4652 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4653 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4654 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4655 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4656 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4657 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4658 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4659 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4660 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4661 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4662 I.getName()), I);
4663 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4664 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
4665 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4666 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
4667 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4668 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4669 I.getName()), I);
4670 }
4671 }
4672
4673 if (Op1)
4674 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4675 break;
4676 }
4677 }
4678
4679 return Changed ? &I : 0;
4680}
4681
4682Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
4683 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
4684 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
4685 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
4686
4687 // icmp X, X
4688 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004689 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4690 isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004691
4692 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004693 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004694
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004695 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004696 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004697 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
4698 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
4699 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00004700 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00004701 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4702 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004703
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004704 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00004705 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004706 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4707 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
4708 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> ~(A^B)
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004709 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004710 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004711 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004712 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004713 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq bool %A, %B -> A^B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004714 return BinaryOperator::createXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004715
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004716 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4717 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4718 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp gt -> icmp lt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004719 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004720 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4721 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp lt bool A, B -> ~X & Y
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004722 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4723 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4724 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Not, Op1);
4725 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004726 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4727 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4728 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ge -> icmp le
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004729 // FALL THROUGH
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004730 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4731 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp le bool %A, %B -> ~A | B
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00004732 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::createNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
4733 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
4734 return BinaryOperator::createOr(Not, Op1);
4735 }
4736 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004737 }
4738
Chris Lattner2be51ae2004-06-09 04:24:29 +00004739 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
4740 // can be folded into the comparison.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00004741 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004742 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
4743 default: break;
4744 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // A <u MIN -> FALSE
4745 if (CI->isMinValue(false))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004746 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004747 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
4748 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0,Op1);
4749 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4750 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004751 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
4752 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
4753 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
4754 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
4755
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004756 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004757
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004758 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4759 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <s MIN -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004760 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004761 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
4762 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4763 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
4764 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4765 break;
4766
4767 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4768 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >u MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004770 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
4771 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4772 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, false)) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4773 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00004774
4775 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
4776 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
4777 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
4778 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004779 break;
4780
4781 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4782 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >s MAX -> FALSE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004783 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004784 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
4785 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
4786 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI, true)) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
4787 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4788 break;
4789
4790 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4791 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004793 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A <=u MIN -> A == MIN
4794 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4795 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,false)) // A <=u MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4796 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4797 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004798
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004799 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4800 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004801 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004802 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A <=s MIN -> A == MIN
4803 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4804 if (isMaxValueMinusOne(CI,true)) // A <=s MAX-1 -> A != MAX
4805 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4806 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004807
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004808 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4809 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004811 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A >=u MAX -> A == MAX
4812 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4813 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,false)) // A >=u MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4814 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4815 break;
4816
4817 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4818 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004819 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004820 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A >=s MAX -> A == MAX
4821 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, Op1);
4822 if (isMinValuePlusOne(CI,true)) // A >=s MIN-1 -> A != MIN
4823 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4824 break;
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004825 }
4826
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004827 // If we still have a icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
4828 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. Since the border cases have
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00004829 // already been handled above, this requires little checking.
4830 //
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004831 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004832 default: break;
4833 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
4834 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4835 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
4836 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
4837 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
4838 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
4839 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
4840 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +00004841 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004842
4843 // See if we can fold the comparison based on bits known to be zero or one
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004844 // in the input. If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
4845 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
4846
4847 bool UnusedBit;
4848 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
4849
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004850 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
4851 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00004852 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
4853 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
4854 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004855 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
4856 return &I;
4857
4858 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
4859 // in.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004860 if ((KnownOne | KnownZero) != 0) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004861 // Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
4862 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004863 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
4864 const APInt& RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004865 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004866 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4867 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004868 } else {
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004869 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min,
4870 Max);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004871 }
4872 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
4873 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
4874 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004875 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004877 break;
4878 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004879 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004880 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004881 break;
4882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004883 if (Max.ult(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004884 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004885 if (Min.uge(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004886 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004887 break;
4888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004889 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004890 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004891 if (Max.ule(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004892 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004893 break;
4894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004895 if (Max.slt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004896 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004897 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004898 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004899 break;
4900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00004901 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004902 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner81973ef2007-04-09 23:52:13 +00004903 if (Max.sle(RHSVal))
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004904 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004905 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00004906 }
4907 }
4908
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004909 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00004910 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004911 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00004912 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004913 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
4914 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004915 }
4916
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00004917 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004918 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
4919 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
4920 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004921 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
4922 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004923 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004924 bool isAllZeros = true;
4925 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
4926 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
4927 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
4928 isAllZeros = false;
4929 break;
4930 }
4931 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004932 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00004933 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
4934 }
4935 break;
4936
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004937 case Instruction::PHI:
4938 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4939 return NV;
4940 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004941 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004942 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
4943 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
4944 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
4945 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
4946 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
4947 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
4948 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004949 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4950 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4951 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4952 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
4953 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004954 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
4955 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004956 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
4957 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
4958 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
4959 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
4960 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004961 }
4962 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00004963
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004964 if (Op1)
4965 return new SelectInst(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
4966 break;
4967 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00004968 case Instruction::Malloc:
4969 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
4970 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
4971 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
4972 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
4973 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
4974 !isTrueWhenEqual(I)));
4975 }
4976 break;
4977 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00004978 }
4979
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004980 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004981 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004982 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004983 return NI;
4984 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004985 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
4986 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00004987 return NI;
4988
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004989 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004990 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
4991 // now.
4992 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
4993 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
4994 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00004995 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
4996 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004997 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004998
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00004999 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
5000 // so eliminate it as well.
5001 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
5002 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005003
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005004 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005005 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType())
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005006 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00005007 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005008 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005009 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00005010 Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005011 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005012 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00005013 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00005014 }
5015
5016 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005017 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005018 // This comes up when you have code like
5019 // int X = A < B;
5020 // if (X) ...
5021 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005022 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
5023 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005024 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005025 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00005026 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005027
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005028 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005029 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5030 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5031 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
5032 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
5033 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5034 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
5035 }
5036
5037 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5038 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
5039 if (ConstantInt *C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(B))
5040 if (ConstantInt *C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D))
5041 if (Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005042 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005043 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::createXor(C, NC, "tmp");
5044 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
5045 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
5046 }
5047
5048 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
5049 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
5050 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
5051 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
5052 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
5053 }
5054 }
5055
5056 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5057 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005058 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
5059 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005060 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
5061 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005062 }
5063 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op1) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005064 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005065 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5066 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00005067 }
5068 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && A == Op0) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005069 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005070 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
5071 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005072 }
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005073
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00005074 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
5075 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
5076 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5077 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5078 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5079
5080 if (A == C) {
5081 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
5082 } else if (A == D) {
5083 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
5084 } else if (B == C) {
5085 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
5086 } else if (B == D) {
5087 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
5088 }
5089
5090 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
5091 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
5092 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
5093 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
5094 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
5095 return &I;
5096 }
5097 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00005098 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005099 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005100}
5101
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005102
5103/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
5104/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
5105Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
5106 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
5107 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5108 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
5109
5110 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
5111 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
5112 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
5113 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
5114 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
5115 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
5116 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
5117 // if it finds it.
5118 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
5119 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
5120 return 0;
5121 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005122 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005123
5124 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
5125 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
5126 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
5127 // instead of computing a divide.
5128 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
5129
5130 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
5131 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
5132 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
5133 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
5134 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
5135
5136 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005137 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005138
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005139 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
5140 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
5141 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
5142 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
5143 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
5144 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
5145 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
5146 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
5147 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
5148
5149
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005150 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005151 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005152 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005153 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5154 if (!HiOverflow)
5155 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005156 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
5157 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005158 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005159 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
5160 HiBound = DivRHS;
5161 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005162 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
5163 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
5164 if (!HiOverflow)
5165 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005166 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005167 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005168 Constant *DivRHSH = ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS));
5169 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod,
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005170 cast<ConstantInt>(DivRHSH), true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005171 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005172 HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005173 }
5174 } else { // Divisor is < 0.
5175 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005176 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005177 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
5178 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005179 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
5180 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
5181 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
5182 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005183 } else if (CmpRHSV.isPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005184 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
5185 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005186 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005187 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, Prod, AddOne(DivRHS), true) ?-1:0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005188 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
5189 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005190 // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005191 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005192 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? 1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005193 HiBound = Subtract(Prod, DivRHS);
5194 }
5195
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005196 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
5197 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005198 }
5199
5200 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005201 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005202 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
5203 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5204 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5205 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5206 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005207 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005208 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
5209 else if (LoOverflow)
5210 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
5211 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
5212 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005213 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005214 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5215 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
5216 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5217 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005218 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005219 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
5220 else if (LoOverflow)
5221 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
5222 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5223 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005224 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005225 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5226 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005227 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
5228 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5229 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005230 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005231 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005232 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5233 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005234 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00005236 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
5237 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5238 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005239 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
5240 else
5241 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
5242 }
5243}
5244
5245
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005246/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
5247///
5248Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
5249 Instruction *LHSI,
5250 ConstantInt *RHS) {
5251 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
5252
5253 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00005254 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005255 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5256 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
5257 // fold the xor.
5258 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0 ||
5259 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue()) {
5260 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
5261
5262 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
5263 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
5264 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
5265 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
5266 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
5267 return &ICI;
5268 }
5269
5270 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
5271 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5272
5273 // If so, the new one isn't.
5274 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
5275
5276 if (isTrueIfPositive)
5277 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
5278 else
5279 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
5280 }
5281 }
5282 break;
5283 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
5284 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
5285 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
5286 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5287
5288 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
5289 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
5290 // produced, eliminating a cast.
5291 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
5292 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
5293 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
5294 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
5295 // bit would not work.
5296 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
5297 (ICI.isEquality() || AndCST->getValue().isPositive() &&
5298 RHSV.isPositive())) {
5299 uint32_t BitWidth =
5300 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
5301 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
5302 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
5303 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
5304 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
5305 Instruction *NewAnd =
5306 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
5307 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
5308 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5309 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
5310 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
5311 }
5312 }
5313
5314 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
5315 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
5316 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
5317 // access.
5318 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
5319 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
5320 Shift = 0;
5321
5322 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
5323 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
5324 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
5325 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
5326
5327 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
5328 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
5329 // rights, as they sign-extend.
5330 if (ShAmt) {
5331 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
5332 if (!CanFold) {
5333 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
5334 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
5335 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5336 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
5337
5338 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5339 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
5340 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
5341 CanFold = true;
5342 }
5343
5344 if (CanFold) {
5345 Constant *NewCst;
5346 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5347 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
5348 else
5349 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
5350
5351 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
5352 // compared.
5353 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
5354 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
5355 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
5356 // result is always true or false now.
5357 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
5358 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5359 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
5360 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5361 } else {
5362 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
5363 Constant *NewAndCST;
5364 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
5365 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
5366 else
5367 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
5368 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
5369 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
5370 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
5371 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
5372 return &ICI;
5373 }
5374 }
5375 }
5376
5377 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
5378 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
5379 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
5380 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
5381 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
5382 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
5383 // Compute C << Y.
5384 Value *NS;
5385 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
5386 NS = BinaryOperator::createShl(AndCST,
5387 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5388 } else {
5389 // Insert a logical shift.
5390 NS = BinaryOperator::createLShr(AndCST,
5391 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
5392 }
5393 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
5394
5395 // Compute X & (C << Y).
5396 Instruction *NewAnd =
5397 BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
5398 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
5399
5400 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
5401 return &ICI;
5402 }
5403 }
5404 break;
5405
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005406 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
5407 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5408 if (!ShAmt) break;
5409
5410 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5411
5412 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5413 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5414 // simplified.
5415 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5416 break;
5417
5418 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5419 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5420 // comparison cannot succeed.
5421 Constant *Comp =
5422 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
5423 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5424 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5425 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5426 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5427 }
5428
5429 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5430 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5431 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5432 Constant *Mask =
5433 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005434
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005435 Instruction *AndI =
5436 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5437 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5438 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5439 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5440 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005441 }
5442 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005443
5444 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
5445 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
5446 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
5447 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
5448 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
5449 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
5450 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
5451 Instruction *AndI =
5452 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5453 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5454 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5455
5456 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
5457 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
5458 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005459 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005460 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005461
5462 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005463 case Instruction::AShr: {
5464 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
5465 if (!ShAmt) break;
5466
5467 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5468 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
5469 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
5470 // simplified.
5471 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
5472 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
5473 break;
5474 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
5475
5476 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
5477 // comparison cannot succeed.
5478 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
5479 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
5480 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
5481 else
5482 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
5483
5484 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
5485 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5486 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
5487 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
5488 }
5489
5490 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() || RHSV == 0) {
5491 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
5492 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
5493 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005494
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005495 Instruction *AndI =
5496 BinaryOperator::createAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
5497 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
5498 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
5499 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
5500 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005501 }
5502 }
5503 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00005504 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005505
5506 case Instruction::SDiv:
5507 case Instruction::UDiv:
5508 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
5509 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
5510 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
5511 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
5512 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
5513 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00005514 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
5515 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
5516 DivRHS))
5517 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005518 break;
5519 }
5520
5521 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
5522 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
5523 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5524
5525 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
5526 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
5527 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
5528 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
5529 case Instruction::SRem:
5530 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
5531 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
5532 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
5533 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
5534 Instruction *NewRem =
5535 BinaryOperator::createURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
5536 BO->getName());
5537 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
5538 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
5539 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
5540 }
5541 }
5542 break;
5543 case Instruction::Add:
5544 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
5545 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5546 if (BO->hasOneUse())
5547 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5548 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
5549 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
5550 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
5551 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
5552 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
5553
5554 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
5555 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
5556 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
5557 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
5558 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
5559 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::createNeg(BOp1);
5560 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
5561 Neg->takeName(BO);
5562 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
5563 }
5564 }
5565 break;
5566 case Instruction::Xor:
5567 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
5568 // the explicit xor.
5569 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5570 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5571 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
5572
5573 // FALLTHROUGH
5574 case Instruction::Sub:
5575 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
5576 if (RHSV == 0)
5577 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
5578 BO->getOperand(1));
5579 break;
5580
5581 case Instruction::Or:
5582 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
5583 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
5584 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5585 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
5586 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
5587 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5588 isICMP_NE));
5589 }
5590 break;
5591
5592 case Instruction::And:
5593 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
5594 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
5595 // comparison can never succeed!
5596 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
5597 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
5598 isICMP_NE));
5599
5600 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
5601 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
5602 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
5603 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
5604 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
5605
5606 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
5607 if (isSignBit(BOC)) {
5608 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5609 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
5610 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5611 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5612 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
5613 }
5614
5615 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
5616 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
5617 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
5618 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
5619 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
5620 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
5621 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
5622 }
5623 }
5624 default: break;
5625 }
5626 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
5627 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
5628 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
5629 AddToWorkList(II);
5630 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
5631 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
5632 return &ICI;
5633 }
5634 }
5635 } else { // Not a ICMP_EQ/ICMP_NE
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00005636 // If the LHS is a cast from an integral value of the same size,
5637 // then since we know the RHS is a constant, try to simlify.
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005638 if (CastInst *Cast = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHSI)) {
5639 Value *CastOp = Cast->getOperand(0);
5640 const Type *SrcTy = CastOp->getType();
5641 uint32_t SrcTySize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5642 if (SrcTy->isInteger() &&
5643 SrcTySize == Cast->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
5644 // If this is an unsigned comparison, try to make the comparison use
5645 // smaller constant values.
5646 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT && RHSV.isSignBit()) {
5647 // X u< 128 => X s> -1
5648 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CastOp,
5649 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTySize)));
5650 } else if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT &&
5651 RHSV == APInt::getSignedMaxValue(SrcTySize)) {
5652 // X u> 127 => X s< 0
5653 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CastOp,
5654 Constant::getNullValue(SrcTy));
5655 }
5656 }
5657 }
5658 }
5659 return 0;
5660}
5661
5662/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
5663/// We only handle extending casts so far.
5664///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005665Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
5666 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00005667 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
5668 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005669 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005670 Value *RHSCIOp;
5671
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005672 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
5673 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
5674 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
5675 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
5676 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
5677 Value *RHSOp = 0;
5678 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00005679 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00005680 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
5681 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
5682 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
5683 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
5684 RHSOp = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, RHSOp,
5685 LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
5686 }
5687
5688 if (RHSOp)
5689 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
5690 }
5691
5692 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
5693 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005694 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
5695 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00005696 return 0;
5697
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005698 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
5699 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005700
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005701 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005702 // Not an extension from the same type?
5703 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005704 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
5705 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00005706
5707 // If the signedness of the two compares doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
5708 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
5709 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
5710 return 0;
5711
5712 // Likewise, if the signedness of the [sz]exts and the compare don't match,
5713 // then we can't handle this.
5714 if (isSignedExt != isSignedCmp && !ICI.isEquality())
5715 return 0;
5716
5717 // Okay, just insert a compare of the reduced operands now!
5718 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00005719 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005720
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005721 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
5722 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
5723 if (!CI)
5724 return 0;
5725
5726 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
5727 // reextended to DestTy.
5728 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
5729 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
5730
5731 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
5732 if (Res2 == CI) {
5733 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
5734 // For example, we might have:
5735 // %A = sext short %X to uint
5736 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
5737 // It is incorrect to transform this into
5738 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
5739 // because %A may have negative value.
5740 //
5741 // However, it is OK if SrcTy is bool (See cast-set.ll testcase)
5742 // OR operation is EQ/NE.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005743 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || SrcTy == Type::Int1Ty || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005744 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
5745 else
5746 return 0;
5747 }
5748
5749 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
5750 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
5751
5752 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
5753 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
5754 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005756 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005758
5759 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
5760 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
5761 Value *Result;
5762 if (isSignedCmp) {
5763 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00005764 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005765 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005766 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005767 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005768 } else {
5769 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
5770 if (isSignedExt) {
5771 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
5772 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005773 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005774 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
5775 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
5776 } else {
5777 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005778 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005779 }
5780 }
5781
5782 // Finally, return the value computed.
5783 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5784 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT) {
5785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
5786 } else {
5787 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
5788 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
5789 "ICmp should be folded!");
5790 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5791 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
5792 else
5793 return BinaryOperator::createNot(Result);
5794 }
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005795}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005796
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005797Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
5798 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5799}
5800
5801Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5802 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5803}
5804
5805Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
5806 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
5807}
5808
5809Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
5810 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005811 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005812
5813 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
5814 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005815 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00005816 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
5817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005818
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005819 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
5820 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00005821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005822 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005823 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
5824 }
5825 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005826 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
5827 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
5828 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005829 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005830 }
5831
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005832 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
5833 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005834 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnerde2b6602006-11-10 23:38:52 +00005835 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005836 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
5837
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005838 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5839 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
5840 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005841 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005842 return R;
5843
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005844 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00005845 if (I.isArithmeticShift()) {
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005846 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
5847 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005848 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Chris Lattner120347e2005-05-08 17:34:56 +00005849 }
5850 }
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005851
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005852 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00005853 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
5854 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005855 return 0;
5856}
5857
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00005858Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005859 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005860 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005861
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005862 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5863 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00005864 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5865 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
5866 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00005867 KnownZero, KnownOne))
5868 return &I;
5869
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005870 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
5871 // of a signed value.
5872 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00005873 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005874 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005875 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5876 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00005877 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005878 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00005879 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005880 }
5881
5882 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
5883 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
5884 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
5885 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
5886 return BinaryOperator::createMul(BO->getOperand(0),
5887 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
5888
5889 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5890 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
5891 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
5892 return R;
5893 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5894 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5895 return NV;
5896
5897 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005898 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
5899 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
5900 Value *V1, *V2;
5901 ConstantInt *CC;
5902 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005903 default: break;
5904 case Instruction::Add:
5905 case Instruction::And:
5906 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005907 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005908 // These operators commute.
5909 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005910 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
5911 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005912 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005913 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005914 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005915 Op0BO->getName());
5916 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005917 Instruction *X =
5918 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
5919 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005920 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005921 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005922 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5923 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005924 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005925
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005926 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005927 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005928 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005929 match(Op0BOOp1,
5930 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00005931 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5932 V2 == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005933 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005934 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
5935 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005936 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5937 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005938 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005939 V1->getName()+".mask");
5940 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5941
5942 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
5943 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005944 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005945
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005946 // FALL THROUGH.
5947 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005948 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005949 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5950 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005951 m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CC))) && CC == Op1) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005952 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005953 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5954 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005955 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005956 Instruction *X =
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005957 BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005958 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005959 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00005960 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00005961 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
5962 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005963 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005964
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005965 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005966 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
5967 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
5968 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005969 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00005970 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
5971 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00005972 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::createShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00005973 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
5974 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005975 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
5976 Instruction *XM =
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005977 BinaryOperator::createAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005978 V1->getName()+".mask");
5979 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
5980
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00005981 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00005982 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005983
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00005984 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00005985 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00005986 }
5987
5988
5989 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
5990 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
5991 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
5992 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
5993 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
5994
5995 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00005996 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00005997 case Instruction::Add:
5998 isValid = isLeftShift;
5999 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00006000 case Instruction::Or:
6001 case Instruction::Xor:
6002 highBitSet = false;
6003 break;
6004 case Instruction::And:
6005 highBitSet = true;
6006 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006007 }
6008
6009 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
6010 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
6011 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
6012 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
6013 // operation.
6014 //
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006015 if (isValid && !isLeftShift && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006016 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006017 }
6018
6019 if (isValid) {
6020 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
6021
6022 Instruction *NewShift =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006023 BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006024 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006025 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006026
6027 return BinaryOperator::create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
6028 NewRHS);
6029 }
6030 }
6031 }
6032 }
6033
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006034 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006035 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
6036 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
6037 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006038
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006039 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006040 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00006041 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6042 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006043 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
6044 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
6045 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006046
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006047 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006048 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
6049 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006050
6051 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
6052
6053 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00006054 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006055 return BinaryOperator::create(I.getOpcode(), X,
6056 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6057 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
6058 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
6059 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
6060 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6061 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
6062 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6063 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
6064 Instruction *Shift =
6065 BinaryOperator::createAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
6066 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6067
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006068 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006069 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006070 }
6071
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006072 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
6073 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
6074 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
6075 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
6076 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006077 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006078 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006079 }
6080 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
6081 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00006082 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006083 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006084 }
6085 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
6086 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
6087 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
6088 // generators.
6089 const Type *SExtType = 0;
6090 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00006091 case 1 :
6092 case 8 :
6093 case 16 :
6094 case 32 :
6095 case 64 :
6096 case 128:
6097 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
6098 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006099 default: break;
6100 }
6101 if (SExtType) {
6102 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
6103 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
6104 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
6105 }
6106 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
6107 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006108 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006109
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006110 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006111 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6112 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6113 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006114 Instruction *Shift =
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006115 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00006116 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6117
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006118 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
6119 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006120 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006121
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006122 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006123 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6124 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6125 Instruction *Shift =
6126 BinaryOperator::createLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6127 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006128
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00006129 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006130 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00006131 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006132
6133 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
6134 } else {
6135 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006136 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006137
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006138 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006139 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6140 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
6141 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
6142 Instruction *Shift =
6143 BinaryOperator::create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
6144 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6145 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6146
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00006147 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006148 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006149 }
6150
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00006151 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006152 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
6153 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
6154 Instruction *Shift =
6155 BinaryOperator::createShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
6156 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
6157
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00006158 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006159 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00006160 }
6161
6162 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006163 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00006164 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006165 return 0;
6166}
6167
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00006168
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006169/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
6170/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
6171/// X*Scale+Offset.
6172///
6173static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006174 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006175 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006176 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006177 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
6178 Scale = 1;
6179 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006180 } else if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val)) {
6181 if (I->getNumOperands() == 2) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006182 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006183 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
6184 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
6185 Scale = 1U << CUI->getZExtValue();
6186 Offset = 0;
6187 return I->getOperand(0);
6188 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
6189 // This value is scaled by 'CUI'.
6190 Scale = CUI->getZExtValue();
6191 Offset = 0;
6192 return I->getOperand(0);
6193 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
6194 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
6195 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
6196 unsigned SubScale;
6197 Value *SubVal =
6198 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
6199 Offset += CUI->getZExtValue();
6200 if (SubScale > 1 && (Offset % SubScale == 0)) {
6201 Scale = SubScale;
6202 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006203 }
6204 }
6205 }
6206 }
6207 }
6208
6209 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
6210 Scale = 1;
6211 Offset = 0;
6212 return Val;
6213}
6214
6215
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006216/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
6217/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006218Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006219 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006220 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006221
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006222 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
6223 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00006224
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006225 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
6226 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
6227 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
6228 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
6229 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
6230
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006231 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00006232 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00006233 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00006234 }
6235 }
6236
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006237 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
6238 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
6239 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
6240 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006241
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00006242 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
6243 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006244 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6245
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006246 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
6247 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
6248 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
6249 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
6250
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006251 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(AllocElTy);
6252 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006253 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00006254
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006255 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
6256 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006257 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
6258 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006259 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
6260 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
6261
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006262 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
6263 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006264 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
6265 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006266
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006267 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
6268 Value *Amt = 0;
6269 if (Scale == 1) {
6270 Amt = NumElements;
6271 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006272 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006273 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
6274 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00006275 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006276 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00006277 else if (Scale != 1) {
6278 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
6279 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00006280 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00006281 }
6282
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00006283 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
6284 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00006285 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::createAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
6286 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
6287 }
6288
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006289 AllocationInst *New;
6290 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006291 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006292 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006293 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006294 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00006295 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006296
6297 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
6298 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
6299 // die soon.
6300 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
6301 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006302 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
6303 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
6304 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00006305 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
6306 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
6307 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00006308 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
6309}
6310
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006311/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006312/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
6313/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
6314/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
6315/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
6316///
6317/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
6318/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
6319static bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006320 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006321 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
6322 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
6323 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006324
6325 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006326 if (!I) return false;
6327
6328 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006329
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006330 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
6331 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
6332 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
6333 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
6334 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
6335 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
6336 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
6337 // casts first.
6338 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)))
6339 ++NumCastsRemoved;
6340 return true;
6341 }
6342 }
6343
6344 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
6345 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
6346 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
6347
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006348 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006349 case Instruction::Add:
6350 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006351 case Instruction::And:
6352 case Instruction::Or:
6353 case Instruction::Xor:
6354 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006355 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6356 NumCastsRemoved) &&
6357 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
6358 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006359
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006360 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006361 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
6362 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
6363 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006364 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6365 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
6366 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006367 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6368 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006369 }
6370 break;
6371 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006372 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
6373 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
6374 // already zeros.
6375 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006376 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
6377 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
6378 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006379 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006380 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
6381 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006382 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
6383 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006384 }
6385 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006386 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006387 case Instruction::ZExt:
6388 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006389 case Instruction::Trunc:
6390 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00006391 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
6392 // of casts in the input.
6393 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006394 return true;
Chris Lattner50d9d772007-09-10 23:46:29 +00006395
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006396 break;
6397 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006398 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6399 break;
6400 }
6401
6402 return false;
6403}
6404
6405/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
6406/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
6407/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006408Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006409 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006410 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006411 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006412
6413 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
6414 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00006415 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006416 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006417 case Instruction::Add:
6418 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006419 case Instruction::And:
6420 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006421 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006422 case Instruction::AShr:
6423 case Instruction::LShr:
6424 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006425 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006426 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
6427 Res = BinaryOperator::create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
6428 LHS, RHS, I->getName());
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00006429 break;
6430 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006431 case Instruction::Trunc:
6432 case Instruction::ZExt:
6433 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006434 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006435 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
6436 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006437 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
6438 return I->getOperand(0);
6439
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006440 // Otherwise, must be the same type of case, so just reinsert a new one.
6441 Res = CastInst::create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
6442 Ty, I->getName());
6443 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006444 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00006445 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
6446 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
6447 break;
6448 }
6449
6450 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
6451}
6452
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006453/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
6454Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00006455 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6456
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00006457 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006458 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006459 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006460 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
6461 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
6462 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
6463 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
6464 return CastInst::create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00006465 }
6466 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00006467
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006468 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006469 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
6470 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
6471 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006472
6473 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00006474 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
6475 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
6476 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00006477
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006478 return 0;
6479}
6480
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006481/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
6482Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6483 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6484
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006485 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006486 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
6487 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006488 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
6489 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
6490 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
6491 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006492 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006493 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
6494 return &CI;
6495 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006496
6497 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
6498 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
6499 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
6500 // non-type-safe code.
6501 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
6502 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
6503 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
6504 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
6505 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
6506
6507 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
6508 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
6509 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
6510 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
6511 if (GEPIdxTy->isSized()) {
6512 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
6513
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006514 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
6515 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
6516 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006517 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006518 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
6519 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeSize(GEPIdxTy)) {
6520 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
6521 Offset %= TySize;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006522
Chris Lattnerc42e2262007-05-05 01:59:31 +00006523 // Handle silly modulus not returning values values [0..TySize).
6524 if (Offset < 0) {
6525 --FirstIdx;
6526 Offset += TySize;
6527 assert(Offset >= 0);
6528 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00006529 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize &&"Out of range offset");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006530 }
6531
6532 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006533
6534 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
6535 while (Offset) {
6536 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6537 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006538 if (Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
6539 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
6540 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006541
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006542 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
6543 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType(Elt);
6544 } else {
6545 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6546 Offset = 0;
6547 OrigBase = 0;
6548 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006549 } else if (isa<ArrayType>(GEPIdxTy) || isa<VectorType>(GEPIdxTy)) {
6550 const SequentialType *STy = cast<SequentialType>(GEPIdxTy);
Chris Lattner6b6aef82007-05-15 00:16:00 +00006551 if (uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeSize(STy->getElementType())) {
6552 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
6553 Offset %= EltSize;
6554 } else {
6555 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, 0));
6556 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006557 GEPIdxTy = STy->getElementType();
6558 } else {
6559 // Otherwise, we can't index into this, bail out.
6560 Offset = 0;
6561 OrigBase = 0;
6562 }
6563 }
6564 if (OrigBase) {
6565 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
6566 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
6567 // two.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00006568 Instruction *NGEP = new GetElementPtrInst(OrigBase,
6569 NewIndices.begin(),
6570 NewIndices.end(), "");
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006571 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
6572 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
6573
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00006574 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
6575 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6576 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
6577 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
6578 }
6579 }
6580 }
6581 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00006582 }
6583
6584 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6585}
6586
6587
6588
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006589/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
6590/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006591/// cases.
6592/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
6593Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
6594 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
6595 return Result;
6596
6597 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6598 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
6599 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006600 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6601 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006602
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006603 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
6604 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006605 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
6606 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006607 KnownZero, KnownOne))
6608 return &CI;
6609
6610 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
6611 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006612 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
6613 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006614 return 0;
6615
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006616 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006617 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006618 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
6619 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006620 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006621 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00006622 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
6623 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
6624 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
6625 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006626 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00006627 bool DoXForm;
6628 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6629 default:
6630 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
6631 // get here because of the check above.
6632 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
6633 case Instruction::Trunc:
6634 DoXForm = true;
6635 break;
6636 case Instruction::ZExt:
6637 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
6638 break;
6639 case Instruction::SExt:
6640 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
6641 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006642 }
6643
6644 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00006645 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
6646 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006647 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
6648 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
6649 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
6650 case Instruction::Trunc:
6651 case Instruction::BitCast:
6652 // Just replace this cast with the result.
6653 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6654 case Instruction::ZExt: {
6655 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
6656 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00006657 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
6658 SrcBitSize));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006659 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(Res, C);
6660 }
6661 case Instruction::SExt:
6662 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
6663 return CastInst::create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006664 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
6665 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006666 }
6667 }
6668 }
6669
6670 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
6671 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
6672
6673 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6674 case Instruction::Add:
6675 case Instruction::Mul:
6676 case Instruction::And:
6677 case Instruction::Or:
6678 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006679 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006680 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
6681 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6682 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6683 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
6684 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006685 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
6686 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00006687 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006688 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6689 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
6690 return BinaryOperator::create(
6691 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006692 }
6693 }
6694
6695 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
6696 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
6697 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006698 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006699 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006700 Value *New = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006701 return BinaryOperator::createXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
6702 }
6703 break;
6704 case Instruction::SDiv:
6705 case Instruction::UDiv:
6706 case Instruction::SRem:
6707 case Instruction::URem:
6708 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
6709 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
6710 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
6711 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
6712 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006713 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
6714 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006715 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6716 Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
6717 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
6718 Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006719 return BinaryOperator::create(
6720 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
6721 }
6722 }
6723 break;
6724
6725 case Instruction::Shl:
6726 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
6727 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
6728 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
6729 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
6730 // in the value.
6731 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
6732 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006733 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
6734 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
6735 Value *Op0c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006736 Value *Op1c = InsertOperandCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, SrcI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006737 return BinaryOperator::createShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006738 }
6739 break;
6740 case Instruction::AShr:
6741 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
6742 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
6743 // simplifications.
6744 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
6745 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006746 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006747 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
6748 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006749 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006750 }
6751 }
6752 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006753 }
6754 return 0;
6755}
6756
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006757Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006758 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6759 return Result;
6760
6761 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6762 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006763 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6764 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006765
6766 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
6767 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
6768 default: break;
6769 case Instruction::LShr:
6770 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
6771 // are already zeros.
6772 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00006773 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006774
6775 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006776 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00006777 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
6778 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006779 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
6780 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
6781
6782 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
6783 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006784 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
6785 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
6786 Ty, CI);
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006787 return BinaryOperator::createLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006788 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006789 } else { // This is a variable shr.
6790
6791 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
6792 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
6793 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006794 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006795 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
6796
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006797 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencercc46cdb2007-02-02 14:08:20 +00006798 BinaryOperator::createShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006799 "tmp"), CI);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006800 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAnd(V,
6801 SrcI->getOperand(0),
6802 "tmp"), CI);
6803 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006804 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00006805 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00006806 }
6807 break;
6808 }
6809 }
6810
6811 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006812}
6813
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006814Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006815 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
6816 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6817 return Result;
6818
6819 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6820
6821 // If this is a cast of a cast
6822 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006823 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
6824 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
6825 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
6826 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
6827 // Get the sizes of the types involved
6828 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00006829 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6830 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6831 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006832 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
6833 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
6834 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00006835 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00006836 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006837 Instruction *And =
6838 BinaryOperator::createAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
6839 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
6840 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
6841 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
6842 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006843 And = CastInst::createIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006844 }
6845 return And;
6846 }
6847 }
6848 }
6849
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006850 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6851 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6852 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6853 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6854 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006855 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006856
6857 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
6858 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
6859 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
6860 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
6861 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6862 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
6863 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
6864 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createLShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006865 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006866 CI);
6867 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
6868 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
6869 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
6870
6871 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
6872 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6873 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006874 In->getName()+".not"),
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00006875 CI);
6876 }
6877
6878 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6879 }
6880
6881
6882
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006883 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6884 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6885 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6886 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6887 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
6888 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
6889 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
6890 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00006891 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
6892 // This only works for EQ and NE
6893 ICI->isEquality()) {
6894 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
6895 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
6896 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6897 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
6898 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6899
6900 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
6901 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
6902 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6903 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
6904 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
6905 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
6906 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
6907 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
6908 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
6909 }
6910
6911 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
6912 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6913 if (ShiftAmt) {
6914 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
6915 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
6916 In = InsertNewInstBefore(
6917 BinaryOperator::createLShr(In,
6918 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
6919 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
6920 }
6921
6922 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
6923 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
6924 In = BinaryOperator::createXor(In, One, "tmp");
6925 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
6926 }
6927
6928 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
6929 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6930 else
6931 return CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
6932 }
6933 }
6934 }
6935 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006936 return 0;
6937}
6938
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006939Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006940 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
6941 return I;
6942
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006943 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
6944
6945 // sext (x <s 0) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
6946 // sext (x >s -1) -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
6947 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src)) {
6948 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
6949 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
6950 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
6951 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
6952 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
6953
6954 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
6955 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
6956 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
6957 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())){
6958 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
6959 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
6960 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
6961 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createAShr(In, Sh,
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00006962 In->getName()+".lobit"),
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00006963 CI);
6964 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
6965 In = CastInst::createIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
6966 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
6967
6968 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
6969 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(In,
6970 In->getName()+".not"), CI);
6971
6972 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
6973 }
6974 }
6975 }
6976
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00006977 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006978}
6979
6980Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(CastInst &CI) {
6981 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6982}
6983
6984Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
6985 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6986}
6987
6988Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006989 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006990}
6991
6992Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(CastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer44c030a2006-11-30 23:13:36 +00006993 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006994}
6995
6996Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
6997 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
6998}
6999
7000Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
7001 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7002}
7003
7004Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007005 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007006}
7007
7008Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(CastInst &CI) {
7009 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7010}
7011
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007012Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007013 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
7014 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
7015 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7016 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7017 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
7018
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007019 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007020 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7021 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007022 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
7023 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
7024 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007025 } else {
7026 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7027 return Result;
7028 }
7029
7030
7031 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
7032 // be replaced by the operand.
7033 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
7034 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
7035
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007036 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007037 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
7038 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
7039 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
7040
7041 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
7042 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
7043 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
7044 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
7045 return V;
7046
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00007047 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
7048 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007049 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
7050 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
7051 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
7052 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
7053 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
7054 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
7055 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
7056 ++NumZeros;
7057 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007058
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007059 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
7060 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
7061 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Chuck Rose IIIc331d302007-09-05 20:36:41 +00007062 return new GetElementPtrInst(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
7063 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007064 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007065 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00007066
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007067 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
7068 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
7069 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
7070 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007071 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
7072 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007073 SVI->getType()->getNumElements()) {
7074 CastInst *Tmp;
7075 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
7076 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
7077 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
7078 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
7079 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
7080 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
7081 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007082 Value *LHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7083 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, &CI);
7084 Value *RHS = InsertOperandCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7085 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007086 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
7087 // know the vector types match #elts.
7088 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00007089 }
7090 }
7091 }
7092 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00007093 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00007094}
7095
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007096/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
7097/// %C = or %A, %B
7098/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
7099/// into:
7100/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
7101/// %D = or %A, %C
7102///
7103/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
7104/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
7105/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
7106///
7107static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
7108 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7109 case Instruction::Add:
7110 case Instruction::Mul:
7111 case Instruction::And:
7112 case Instruction::Or:
7113 case Instruction::Xor:
7114 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
7115 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
7116 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007117 case Instruction::LShr:
7118 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007119 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007120 default:
7121 return 0; // Cannot fold
7122 }
7123}
7124
7125/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
7126/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
7127static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
7128 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
7129 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
7130 case Instruction::Add:
7131 case Instruction::Sub:
7132 case Instruction::Or:
7133 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007134 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00007135 case Instruction::LShr:
7136 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007137 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007138 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00007139 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007140 case Instruction::Mul:
7141 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
7142 }
7143}
7144
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007145/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
7146/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
7147Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
7148 Instruction *FI) {
7149 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
7150 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
7151 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007152 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007153 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
7154 return 0;
7155 } else {
7156 return 0; // unknown unary op.
7157 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007158
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007159 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
7160 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
7161 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
7162 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007163 return CastInst::create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
7164 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007165 }
7166
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007167 // Only handle binary operators here.
7168 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007169 return 0;
7170
7171 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
7172 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
7173 bool MatchIsOpZero;
7174 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7175 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7176 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7177 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7178 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7179 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7180 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7181 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7182 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7183 MatchIsOpZero = false;
7184 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
7185 return 0;
7186 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
7187 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
7188 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
7189 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
7190 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7191 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
7192 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
7193 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
7194 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
7195 MatchIsOpZero = true;
7196 } else {
7197 return 0;
7198 }
7199
7200 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
7201 SelectInst *NewSI = new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
7202 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
7203 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
7204
7205 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
7206 if (MatchIsOpZero)
7207 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
7208 else
7209 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007210 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007211 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
7212 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007213}
7214
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007215Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007216 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
7217 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
7218 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
7219
7220 // select true, X, Y -> X
7221 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007222 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007223 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007224
7225 // select C, X, X -> X
7226 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
7227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7228
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007229 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
7230 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7231 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
7232 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7233 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
7234 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7236 else
7237 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7238 }
7239
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007240 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007241 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007242 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007243 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007244 return BinaryOperator::createOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007245 } else {
7246 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
7247 Value *NotCond =
7248 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7249 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007250 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007251 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00007252 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00007253 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007254 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007255 return BinaryOperator::createAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007256 } else {
7257 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
7258 Value *NotCond =
7259 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
7260 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00007261 return BinaryOperator::createOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007262 }
7263 }
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007264 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00007265
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007266 // Selecting between two integer constants?
7267 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
7268 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007269 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007270 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007271 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007272 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007273 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007274 Value *NotCond =
7275 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::createNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007276 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007277 return CastInst::create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00007278 }
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007279
7280 // FIXME: Turn select 0/-1 and -1/0 into sext from condition!
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007281
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007282 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007283
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007284 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007285 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007286 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007287 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007288 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007289 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007290 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007291 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007292 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
7293 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::create(Instruction::AShr, X,
7294 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007295 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
7296
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007297 // Finally, convert to the type of the select RHS. We figure out
7298 // if this requires a SExt, Trunc or BitCast based on the sizes.
7299 Instruction::CastOps opc = Instruction::BitCast;
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007300 uint32_t SRASize = SRA->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7301 uint32_t SISize = SI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007302 if (SRASize < SISize)
7303 opc = Instruction::SExt;
7304 else if (SRASize > SISize)
7305 opc = Instruction::Trunc;
7306 return CastInst::create(opc, SRA, SI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007307 }
7308 }
7309
7310
7311 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00007312 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007313 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
7314 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007315 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00007316 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007317 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
7318 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
7319 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007320 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
7321 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
7322 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007323 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
7324 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007325 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
7326 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00007327 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007328 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00007329 Value *V = ICA;
7330 if (ShouldNotVal)
7331 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::create(
7332 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
7333 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
7334 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00007335 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00007336 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007337
7338 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007339 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7340 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007341 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007342 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007343 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7344 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007345 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7347 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7348
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007349 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007350 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007351 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007352 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007353 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007354 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
7355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7356 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7357 }
7358 }
7359
7360 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
7361 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal)) {
7362 if (ICI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
7363 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
7364 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7365 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7366 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
7367 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
7368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
7369 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7370
7371 } else if (ICI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && ICI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
7372 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
7373 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
7374 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
7375 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
7376 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Chris Lattnerfbede522004-04-11 01:39:19 +00007377 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00007378 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX/ABS/etc.
7379 }
7380 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007381
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007382 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7383 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7384 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007385 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
7386
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00007387 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
7388 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
7389 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
7390 return IV;
7391
7392 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
7393 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007394 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7395 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7396 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
7397 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
7398 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7399 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
7400 }
7401
7402 if (AddOp) {
7403 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
7404 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
7405 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
7406 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
7407 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
7408 }
7409
7410 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007411 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
7412 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
7413 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
7414 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
7415 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
7416 } else {
7417 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
7418 BinaryOperator::createNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007419 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00007420
7421 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
7422 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
7423 if (AddOp != TI)
7424 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
7425 Instruction *NewSel =
7426 new SelectInst(CondVal, NewTrueOp,NewFalseOp,SI.getName()+".p");
7427
7428 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
7429 return BinaryOperator::createAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00007430 }
7431 }
7432 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007433
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007434 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00007435 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007436 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
7437 // transformation we are doing here.
7438 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
7439 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7440 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
7441 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
7442 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7443 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
7444 OpToFold = 1;
7445 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
7446 OpToFold = 2;
7447 }
7448
7449 if (OpToFold) {
7450 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007451 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007452 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007453 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007454 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007455 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
7456 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007457 else {
7458 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
7459 }
7460 }
7461 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00007462
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007463 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
7464 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
7465 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
7466 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
7467 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
7468 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
7469 OpToFold = 1;
7470 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
7471 OpToFold = 2;
7472 }
7473
7474 if (OpToFold) {
7475 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007476 Instruction *NewSel =
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007477 new SelectInst(SI.getCondition(), C, FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007478 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007479 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007480 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
7481 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007482 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007483 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00007484 }
7485 }
7486 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00007487
7488 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
7489 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
7490 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
7491 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
7492 return &SI;
7493 }
7494
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007495 return 0;
7496}
7497
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007498/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
7499/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
7500/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
7501/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
7502static unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V, TargetData *TD,
7503 unsigned PrefAlign = 0) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007504 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V)) {
7505 unsigned Align = GV->getAlignment();
7506 if (Align == 0 && TD)
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007507 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(GV->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007508
7509 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
7510 // of the global.
7511 if (PrefAlign > Align && GV->hasInitializer()) {
7512 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
7513 Align = PrefAlign;
7514 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007515 return Align;
7516 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
7517 unsigned Align = AI->getAlignment();
7518 if (Align == 0 && TD) {
7519 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI))
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007520 Align = TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007521 else if (isa<MallocInst>(AI)) {
7522 // Malloc returns maximally aligned memory.
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007523 Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AI->getType()->getElementType());
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007524 Align =
7525 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007526 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::DoubleTy));
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007527 Align =
7528 std::max(Align,
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007529 (unsigned)TD->getABITypeAlignment(Type::Int64Ty));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007530 }
7531 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007532
7533 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
7534 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
7535 if (PrefAlign > Align && isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
7536 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
7537 Align = PrefAlign;
7538 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007539 return Align;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007540 } else if (isa<BitCastInst>(V) ||
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007541 (isa<ConstantExpr>(V) &&
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007542 cast<ConstantExpr>(V)->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007543 return GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(cast<User>(V)->getOperand(0),
7544 TD, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007545 } else if (User *GEPI = dyn_castGetElementPtr(V)) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007546 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
7547 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
7548 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
7549 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i)) ||
7550 !cast<Constant>(GEPI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
7551 AllZeroOperands = false;
7552 break;
7553 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007554
7555 if (AllZeroOperands) {
7556 // Treat this like a bitcast.
7557 return GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0), TD, PrefAlign);
7558 }
7559
7560 unsigned BaseAlignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(GEPI->getOperand(0),TD);
7561 if (BaseAlignment == 0) return 0;
7562
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007563 // Otherwise, if the base alignment is >= the alignment we expect for the
7564 // base pointer type, then we know that the resultant pointer is aligned at
7565 // least as much as its type requires.
7566 if (!TD) return 0;
7567
7568 const Type *BasePtrTy = GEPI->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007569 const PointerType *PtrTy = cast<PointerType>(BasePtrTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007570 unsigned Align = TD->getABITypeAlignment(PtrTy->getElementType());
7571 if (Align <= BaseAlignment) {
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007572 const Type *GEPTy = GEPI->getType();
Chris Lattner58092e32007-01-20 22:35:55 +00007573 const PointerType *GEPPtrTy = cast<PointerType>(GEPTy);
Lauro Ramos Venancioc7d11142007-07-31 20:13:21 +00007574 Align = std::min(Align, (unsigned)
7575 TD->getABITypeAlignment(GEPPtrTy->getElementType()));
7576 return Align;
Chris Lattner51c26e92006-03-07 01:28:57 +00007577 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007578 return 0;
7579 }
7580 return 0;
7581}
7582
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00007583
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007584/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
7585/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
7586/// the heavy lifting.
7587///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007588Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007589 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
7590 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
7591
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007592 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
7593 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007594 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007595 bool Changed = false;
7596
7597 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
7598 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
7599 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7600
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007601 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007602 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007603 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
7604 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
7605 // alignment is sufficient.
7606 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00007607 }
7608
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007609 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
7610 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
7611 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007612 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007613 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
7614 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
7615 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007616 const char *Name;
Andrew Lenharth8ed4c472006-11-03 22:45:50 +00007617 if (CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType()->getParamType(2) ==
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007618 Type::Int32Ty)
Chris Lattner21959392006-03-03 01:34:17 +00007619 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i32";
7620 else
7621 Name = "llvm.memcpy.i64";
Chris Lattner92141962007-01-07 06:58:05 +00007622 Constant *MemCpy = M->getOrInsertFunction(Name,
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007623 CI.getCalledFunction()->getFunctionType());
7624 CI.setOperand(0, MemCpy);
7625 Changed = true;
7626 }
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007627 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007628
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007629 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
7630 // set, update the alignment.
7631 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007632 unsigned Alignment1 = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1), TD);
7633 unsigned Alignment2 = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2), TD);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007634 unsigned Align = std::min(Alignment1, Alignment2);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007635 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Align) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007636 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Align));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007637 Changed = true;
7638 }
7639 } else if (isa<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007640 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest(), TD);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007641 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007642 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00007643 Changed = true;
7644 }
7645 }
7646
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007647 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007648 } else {
7649 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
7650 default: break;
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007651 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
7652 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007653 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
7654 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
7655 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
7656 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
7657 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007658 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007659 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007660 PointerType::get(II->getType()), CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007661 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
7662 }
7663 break;
7664 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
7665 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
7666 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007667 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007668 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007669 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(2),
7670 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattner82ed58f2006-04-02 05:30:25 +00007671 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
7672 }
7673 break;
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007674 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
7675 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
7676 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
7677 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storel_dq:
7678 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00007679 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), TD, 16) >= 16) {
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007680 const Type *OpPtrTy = PointerType::get(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007681 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, II->getOperand(1),
7682 OpPtrTy, CI);
Chris Lattnerfd6bdf02006-04-17 22:26:56 +00007683 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
7684 }
7685 break;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007686
7687 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
7688 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
7689 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
7690 uint64_t UndefElts;
7691 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
7692 UndefElts)) {
7693 II->setOperand(1, V);
7694 return II;
7695 }
7696 break;
7697 }
7698
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007699 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
7700 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00007701 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007702 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
7703
7704 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
7705 bool AllEltsOk = true;
7706 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7707 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
7708 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
7709 AllEltsOk = false;
7710 break;
7711 }
7712 }
7713
7714 if (AllEltsOk) {
7715 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007716 Value *Op0 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7717 II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType(), CI);
7718 Value *Op1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7719 II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType(), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007720 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
7721
7722 // Only extract each element once.
7723 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
7724 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
7725
7726 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
7727 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
7728 continue;
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00007729 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007730 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
7731
7732 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
7733 Instruction *Elt =
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007734 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007735 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
7736 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
7737 }
7738
7739 // Insert this value into the result vector.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00007740 Result = new InsertElementInst(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx], i,"tmp");
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007741 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
7742 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007743 return CastInst::create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00007744 }
7745 }
7746 break;
7747
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00007748 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
7749 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
7750 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
7751 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
7752 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
7753 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
7754 if (&*++BI == II)
7755 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7756 }
7757 }
7758
7759 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
7760 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
7761 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
7762 if (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)) {
7763 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
7764 bool CannotRemove = false;
7765 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
7766 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) ||
7767 (isa<CallInst>(BI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BI))) {
7768 CannotRemove = true;
7769 break;
7770 }
7771 }
7772 if (!CannotRemove)
7773 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
7774 }
7775 break;
7776 }
7777 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00007778 }
7779
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00007780 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007781}
7782
7783// InvokeInst simplification
7784//
7785Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007786 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007787}
7788
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007789// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
7790//
7791Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007792 bool Changed = false;
7793
7794 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
7795 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007796 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
7797
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007798 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007799
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007800 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
7801 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
7802 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
7803 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
7804 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007805 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007806 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00007807 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
7808 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
7809 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
7810 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
7811 return 0;
7812 }
7813
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007814 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
7815 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
7816 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
7817 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007818 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00007819 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007820 CS.getInstruction());
7821
7822 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
7823 CS.getInstruction()->
7824 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
7825
7826 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
7827 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
7828 new BranchInst(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007829 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007830 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00007831 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
7832 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007833
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007834 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
7835 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
7836 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
7837 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
7838 // the call.
7839 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
7840 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I)
7841 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I)) {
7842 // If this cast does not effect the value passed through the varargs
7843 // area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
7844 Value *Op = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007845 if (CI->isLosslessCast()) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007846 *I = Op;
7847 Changed = true;
7848 }
7849 }
7850 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007851
Duncan Sandsb84abcd2007-09-11 14:35:41 +00007852 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)) {
7853 IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0));
7854 if (In && In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline) {
7855 Function *NestF =
7856 cast<Function>(IntrinsicInst::StripPointerCasts(In->getOperand(2)));
7857 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
7858 const FunctionType *NestFTy =
7859 cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
7860
7861 if (const ParamAttrsList *NestAttrs = NestFTy->getParamAttrs()) {
7862 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
7863 const Type *NestTy = 0;
7864 uint16_t NestAttr;
7865
7866 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
7867
7868 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
7869 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
7870 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
7871 if (NestAttrs->paramHasAttr(NestIdx, ParamAttr::Nest)) {
7872 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
7873 NestTy = *I;
7874 NestAttr = NestAttrs->getParamAttrs(NestIdx);
7875 break;
7876 }
7877
7878 if (NestTy) {
7879 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
7880 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
7881
7882 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
7883 // mean appending it.
7884 {
7885 unsigned Idx = 1;
7886 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
7887 do {
7888 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
7889 // Add the chain argument.
7890 Value *NestVal = In->getOperand(3);
7891 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
7892 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
7893 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
7894 }
7895
7896 if (I == E)
7897 break;
7898
7899 // Add the original argument.
7900 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
7901
7902 ++Idx, ++I;
7903 } while (1);
7904 }
7905
7906 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
7907 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
7908 // with the chain parameter inserted. Likewise for attributes.
7909
7910 const ParamAttrsList *Attrs = FTy->getParamAttrs();
7911 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
7912 ParamAttrsVector NewAttrs;
7913 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
7914
7915 // Add any function result attributes.
7916 uint16_t Attr = Attrs ? Attrs->getParamAttrs(0) : 0;
7917 if (Attr)
7918 NewAttrs.push_back (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
7919
7920 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
7921 // mean appending it. Likewise for the chain's attributes.
7922 {
7923 unsigned Idx = 1;
7924 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
7925 E = FTy->param_end();
7926
7927 do {
7928 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
7929 // Add the chain's type and attributes.
7930 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
7931 NewAttrs.push_back(ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
7932 }
7933
7934 if (I == E)
7935 break;
7936
7937 // Add the original type and attributes.
7938 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
7939 Attr = Attrs ? Attrs->getParamAttrs(Idx) : 0;
7940 if (Attr)
7941 NewAttrs.push_back
7942 (ParamAttrsWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
7943
7944 ++Idx, ++I;
7945 } while (1);
7946 }
7947
7948 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
7949 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
7950 FunctionType *NewFTy =
7951 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg(),
7952 ParamAttrsList::get(NewAttrs));
7953 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::get(NewFTy) ?
7954 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::get(NewFTy));
7955
7956 Instruction *NewCaller;
7957 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
7958 NewCaller = new InvokeInst(NewCallee, II->getNormalDest(),
7959 II->getUnwindDest(), NewArgs.begin(),
7960 NewArgs.end(), Caller->getName(),
7961 Caller);
7962 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
7963 } else {
7964 NewCaller = new CallInst(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
7965 Caller->getName(), Caller);
7966 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
7967 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
7968 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
7969 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
7970 }
7971 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
7972 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
7973 Caller->eraseFromParent();
7974 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
7975 return 0;
7976 }
7977 }
7978
7979 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no
7980 // 'nest' parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let
7981 // the generic code sort out any function type mismatches.
7982 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PTy ?
7983 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
7984 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
7985 Changed = true;
7986 }
7987 }
7988
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00007989 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00007990}
7991
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00007992// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
7993// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
7994//
7995bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
7996 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
7997 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007998 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
7999 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008000 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00008001 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008002 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
8003
8004 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
8005 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
8006 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
8007 //
8008 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
8009 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
8010
Chris Lattnera2b18de2007-05-19 06:51:32 +00008011 const FunctionType *ActualFT =
8012 cast<FunctionType>(cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType());
8013
8014 // If the parameter attributes don't match up, don't do the xform. We don't
8015 // want to lose an sret attribute or something.
8016 if (FT->getParamAttrs() != ActualFT->getParamAttrs())
8017 return false;
8018
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008019 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
8020 if (OldRetTy != FT->getReturnType()) {
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008021 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !Caller->use_empty() &&
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00008022 // Conversion is ok if changing from pointer to int of same size.
8023 !(isa<PointerType>(FT->getReturnType()) &&
8024 TD->getIntPtrType() == OldRetTy))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008025 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008026
8027 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
8028 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
8029 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
8030 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
8031 if (!Caller->use_empty())
8032 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
8033 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
8034 UI != E; ++UI)
8035 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
8036 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008037 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00008038 return false;
8039 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008040
8041 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
8042 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008043
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008044 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
8045 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
8046 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008047 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008048 ConstantInt *c = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(*AI);
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00008049 //Some conversions are safe even if we do not have a body.
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00008050 //Either we can cast directly, or we can upconvert the argument
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00008051 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Chris Lattner46013f42007-01-06 19:53:32 +00008052 (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) && isa<PointerType>(ActTy)) ||
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008053 (ParamTy->isInteger() && ActTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00008054 ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ||
8055 (c && ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00008056 && c->getValue().isStrictlyPositive());
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008057 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Dale Johannesen16ff3042007-04-04 19:16:42 +00008058
8059 // Most other conversions can be done if we have a body, even if these
8060 // lose information, e.g. int->short.
8061 // Some conversions cannot be done at all, e.g. float to pointer.
8062 // Logic here parallels CastInst::getCastOpcode (the design there
8063 // requires legality checks like this be done before calling it).
8064 if (ParamTy->isInteger()) {
8065 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
8066 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
8067 return false;
8068 }
8069 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint() &&
8070 !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
8071 return false;
8072 } else if (ParamTy->isFloatingPoint()) {
8073 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
8074 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != ParamTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
8075 return false;
8076 }
8077 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !ActTy->isFloatingPoint())
8078 return false;
8079 } else if (const VectorType *VParamTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ParamTy)) {
8080 if (const VectorType *VActTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(ActTy)) {
8081 if (VActTy->getBitWidth() != VParamTy->getBitWidth())
8082 return false;
8083 }
8084 if (VParamTy->getBitWidth() != ActTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
8085 return false;
8086 } else if (isa<PointerType>(ParamTy)) {
8087 if (!ActTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(ActTy))
8088 return false;
8089 } else {
8090 return false;
8091 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008092 }
8093
8094 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00008095 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008096 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body...
8097
8098 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
8099 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
8100 std::vector<Value*> Args;
8101 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
8102
8103 AI = CS.arg_begin();
8104 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8105 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
8106 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
8107 Args.push_back(*AI);
8108 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008109 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008110 false, ParamTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008111 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008112 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008113 }
8114 }
8115
8116 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
8117 // now...
8118 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
8119 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
8120
8121 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
8122 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs)
8123 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00008124 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
8125 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008126 } else {
8127 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
8128 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
8129 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
8130 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
8131 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008132 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
8133 PTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008134 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008135 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
8136 Args.push_back(Cast);
8137 } else {
8138 Args.push_back(*AI);
8139 }
8140 }
8141 }
8142
8143 if (FT->getReturnType() == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008144 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008145
8146 Instruction *NC;
8147 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00008148 NC = new InvokeInst(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
David Greenef1355a52007-08-27 19:04:21 +00008149 Args.begin(), Args.end(), Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00008150 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008151 } else {
Chris Lattner684b22d2007-08-02 16:53:43 +00008152 NC = new CallInst(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
8153 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00008154 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
8155 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Chris Lattnere4370262005-05-14 12:25:32 +00008156 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008157 }
8158
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00008159 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008160 Value *NV = NC;
8161 if (Caller->getType() != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
8162 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008163 const Type *CallerTy = Caller->getType();
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008164 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
8165 CallerTy, false);
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00008166 NV = NC = CastInst::create(opcode, NC, CallerTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00008167
8168 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
8169 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
8170 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
8171 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->begin();
8172 while (isa<PHINode>(I)) ++I;
8173 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
8174 } else {
8175 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
8176 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
8177 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008178 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008179 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00008180 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008181 }
8182 }
8183
8184 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
8185 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00008186 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00008187 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008188 return true;
8189}
8190
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008191/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
8192/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
8193/// and a single binop.
8194Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8195 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008196 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) ||
8197 isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008198 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008199 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8200 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
8201
8202 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
8203 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008204
8205 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
8206 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008207 for (unsigned i = 0; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008208 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00008209 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008210 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008211 // types or GEP's with different index types.
8212 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
8213 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008214 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008215
8216 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
8217 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
8218 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
8219 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
8220 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008221
8222 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
8223 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
8224 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008225 }
8226
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008227 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform, determine if it is profitable.
8228
8229 // If this is a GEP, and if the index (not the pointer) needs a PHI, bail out.
8230 // Indexes are often folded into load/store instructions, so we don't want to
8231 // hide them behind a phi.
8232 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst) && RHSVal == 0)
8233 return 0;
8234
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008235 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008236 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008237 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008238 if (LHSVal == 0) {
8239 NewLHS = new PHINode(LHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName()+".pn");
8240 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8241 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008242 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
8243 LHSVal = NewLHS;
8244 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008245
8246 if (RHSVal == 0) {
8247 NewRHS = new PHINode(RHSType, FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName()+".pn");
8248 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
8249 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008250 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
8251 RHSVal = NewRHS;
8252 }
8253
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00008254 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
8255 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8256 if (NewLHS) {
8257 Value *NewInLHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8258 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8259 }
8260 if (NewRHS) {
8261 Value *NewInRHS =cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(1);
8262 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8263 }
8264 }
8265
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008266 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008267 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008268 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8269 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
8270 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008271 else {
8272 assert(isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst));
8273 return new GetElementPtrInst(LHSVal, RHSVal);
8274 }
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008275}
8276
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008277/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
8278/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
8279/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
8280/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008281///
8282/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
8283/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
8284/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008285static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
8286 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
8287
8288 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
8289 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
8290 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +00008291
8292 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
8293 // profitable to do this xform.
8294 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
8295 bool isAddressTaken = false;
8296 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
8297 UI != E; ++UI) {
8298 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
8299 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
8300 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
8301 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
8302 }
8303 isAddressTaken = true;
8304 break;
8305 }
8306
8307 if (!isAddressTaken)
8308 return false;
8309 }
8310
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008311 return true;
8312}
8313
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00008314
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008315// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
8316// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
8317// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
8318Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
8319 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
8320
8321 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
8322 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
8323 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
8324 // code size and simplifying code.
8325 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
8326 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008327 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008328 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
8329 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008330 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008331 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
8332 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008333 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00008334 if (ConstantOp == 0)
8335 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008336 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
8337 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
8338 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
8339 // load and the PHI.
8340 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
8341 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8342 return 0;
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008343 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00008344 if (FirstInst->getNumOperands() == 2)
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00008345 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
8346 // Can't handle general GEPs yet.
8347 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008348 } else {
8349 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
8350 }
8351
8352 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
8353 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8354 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
8355 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008356 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008357 return 0;
8358 if (CastSrcTy) {
8359 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
8360 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008361 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008362 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
8363 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008364 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
8365 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
8366 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
8367 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008368 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
8369 return 0;
8370 }
8371 }
8372
8373 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
8374 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
8375 PHINode *NewPN = new PHINode(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
8376 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00008377 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008378
8379 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
8380 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008381
8382 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008383 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8384 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
8385 if (NewInVal != InVal)
8386 InVal = 0;
8387 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
8388 }
8389
8390 Value *PhiVal;
8391 if (InVal) {
8392 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
8393 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
8394 PhiVal = InVal;
8395 delete NewPN;
8396 } else {
8397 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
8398 PhiVal = NewPN;
8399 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008400
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008401 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008402 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
8403 return CastInst::create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008404 else if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +00008405 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008406 else if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +00008407 return BinaryOperator::create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008408 else if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
8409 return CmpInst::create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
8410 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008411 else
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008412 assert(0 && "Unknown operation");
Jeff Cohenca5183d2007-03-05 00:00:42 +00008413 return 0;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00008414}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008415
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008416/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
8417/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008418static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
8419 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008420 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
8421 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
8422
8423 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008424 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008425 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +00008426
8427 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
8428 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
8429 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008430
8431 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
8432 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008433
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +00008434 return false;
8435}
8436
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008437// PHINode simplification
8438//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008439Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +00008440 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +00008441 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +00008442
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008443 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
8444 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
8445
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008446 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
8447 // reducing code size.
8448 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
8449 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
8450 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
8451 return Result;
8452
8453 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
8454 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
8455 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008456 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
8457 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
8458 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +00008459 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008460 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
8461 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
8462 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8463 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +00008464
8465 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
8466 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
8467 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
8468 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
8469 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
8470 // late.
8471 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
8472 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
8473 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
8474 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
8475 }
8476 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +00008477
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +00008478 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +00008479}
8480
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008481static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
8482 Instruction *InsertPoint,
8483 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00008484 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8485 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008486 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
8487 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
8488 // used for address computation.
8489 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
8490 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
8491 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
8492 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008493}
8494
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008495
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008496Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008497 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008498 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00008499 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008500 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008501 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008502
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008503 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
8504 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
8505
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008506 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
8507 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
8508 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
8509
8510 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008511 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00008512
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008513 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
8514 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008515
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008516 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008517 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEP.getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008518 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
8519 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(GEP.getOperand(i))) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00008520 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
8521 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
8522 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
8523 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
8524 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
8525 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
8526 MadeChange = true;
8527 GEP.setOperand(i, CI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008528 }
8529 }
8530 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008531 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
8532 // to what we need. If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
8533 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
8534 // obvious.
8535 Value *Op = GEP.getOperand(i);
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008536 if (TD->getTypeSize(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSize())
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008537 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008538 GEP.setOperand(i, ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +00008539 MadeChange = true;
8540 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008541 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
8542 GEP);
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +00008543 GEP.setOperand(i, Op);
8544 MadeChange = true;
8545 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008546 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008547 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008548 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
8549
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008550 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, and if the input operand
8551 // is a bitcast of another pointer, just replace the GEP with a bitcast of the
8552 // real input to the dest type.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008553 if (GEP.hasAllZeroIndices() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +00008554 return new BitCastInst(cast<BitCastInst>(GEP.getOperand(0))->getOperand(0),
8555 GEP.getType());
8556
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008557 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
8558 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
8559 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
8560 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008561 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00008562 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008563 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008564
8565 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008566 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
8567 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
8568 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
8569 //
8570 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
8571 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
8572 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
8573
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +00008574 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008575
8576 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
8577 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
8578 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
8579 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +00008580 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008581
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008582 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008583 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +00008584 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
8585 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
8586 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008587 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008588 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
8589 Sum = GO1;
8590 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
8591 Sum = SO1;
8592 } else {
8593 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
8594 // target's pointer size.
8595 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
8596 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008597 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008598 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008599 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008600 } else {
8601 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSize();
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008602 if (TD->getTypeSize(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008603 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008604 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008605
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008606 } else if (TD->getTypeSize(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008607 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008608 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008609 } else {
8610 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008611 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
8612 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008613 }
8614 }
8615 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008616 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
8617 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
8618 else {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00008619 Sum = BinaryOperator::createAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
8620 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008621 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008622 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008623
8624 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
8625 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
8626 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
8627 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
8628 return &GEP;
8629 } else {
8630 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8631 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
8632 Indices.push_back(Sum);
8633 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
8634 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008635 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +00008636 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008637 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008638 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +00008639 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
8640 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +00008641 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
8642 }
8643
8644 if (!Indices.empty())
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008645 return new GetElementPtrInst(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
8646 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008647
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +00008648 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008649 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
8650 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
8651
8652 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008653 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008654 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
8655 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
8656 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
8657
8658 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008659 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
8660 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +00008661
8662 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
8663 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
8664 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008665 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008666 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
8667 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
8668 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
8669 // transform: GEP (cast [10 x ubyte]* X to [0 x ubyte]*), long 0, ...
8670 // into : GEP [10 x ubyte]* X, long 0, ...
8671 //
8672 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
8673 //
8674 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
8675 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
8676 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
8677 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
8678 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
8679 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
8680 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
8681 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
8682 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
8683 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
8684 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
8685 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
8686 return &GEP;
8687 }
8688 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
8689 // Transform things like:
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008690 // %t = getelementptr ubyte* cast ([2 x int]* %str to uint*), uint %V
8691 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x int*]* %str, int 0, uint %V; cast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008692 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
8693 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
8694 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
8695 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
8696 TD->getTypeSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008697 Value *Idx[2];
8698 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8699 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +00008700 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008701 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008702 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
8703 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008704 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008705
8706 // Transform things like:
8707 // getelementptr sbyte* cast ([100 x double]* X to sbyte*), int %tmp
8708 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
8709 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, int 0, int %tmp.2
8710
8711 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008712 (ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty || ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty)) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008713 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
8714 TD->getTypeSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
8715
8716 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
8717 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
8718 Value *NewIdx = 0;
8719 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
8720 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
8721 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
8722 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
8723 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +00008724 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008725 Scale = CI;
8726 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
8727 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
8728 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00008729 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8730 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
8731 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008732 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8733 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
8734 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
8735 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
8736 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
8737 }
8738 }
8739
8740 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
8741 // out, perform the transformation.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008742 if (Scale && Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008743 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Scale))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008744 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
8745 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
8746 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008747 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
8748 true /*SExt*/);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008749 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::createMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
8750 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
8751 }
8752
8753 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008754 Value *Idx[2];
8755 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8756 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008757 Instruction *NewGEP =
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008758 new GetElementPtrInst(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008759 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
8760 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
8761 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +00008762 }
8763 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +00008764 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008765 }
8766
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008767 return 0;
8768}
8769
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008770Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
8771 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
8772 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00008773 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8774 const Type *NewTy =
8775 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008776 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008777
8778 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
8779 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008780 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008781 else {
8782 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +00008783 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +00008784 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008785
8786 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008787
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008788 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
8789 // allocas if possible...
8790 //
8791 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
8792 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
8793
8794 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
8795 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
8796 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00008797 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +00008798 Value *Idx[2];
8799 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
8800 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
8801 Value *V = new GetElementPtrInst(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
Chris Lattner693787a2005-05-04 19:10:26 +00008802 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008803
8804 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
8805 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008806 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008807 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
8808 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008809 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008810
8811 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
8812 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
8813 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008814 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Chris Lattnercf27afb2004-07-02 22:55:47 +00008815 TD->getTypeSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +00008816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
8817
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00008818 return 0;
8819}
8820
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008821Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
8822 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
8823
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008824 // free undef -> unreachable.
8825 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
8826 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008827 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008828 UndefValue::get(PointerType::get(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008829 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8830 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00008831
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008832 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
8833 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00008834 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00008835 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +00008836
8837 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
8838 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
8839 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
8840 return &FI;
8841 }
8842
8843 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
8844 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
8845 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8846 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
8847 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
8848 return &FI;
8849 }
8850 }
8851
8852 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
8853 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
8854 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
8855 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
8856 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
8857 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +00008858
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +00008859 return 0;
8860}
8861
8862
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00008863/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008864static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI) {
8865 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008866 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008867
8868 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008869 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008870 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008871
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008872 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008873 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008874 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
8875 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
8876 // constants.
8877 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
8878 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
8879 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00008880 Value *Idxs[2];
8881 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8882 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008883 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
8884 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
8885 }
8886
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008887 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008888 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +00008889 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
8890 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
8891 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00008892 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
8893 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008894
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008895 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
8896 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
8897 // the result of the loaded value.
8898 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
8899 CI->getName(),
8900 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
8901 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00008902 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +00008903 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +00008904 }
8905 }
8906 return 0;
8907}
8908
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008909/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008910/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
8911/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
8912/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
8913static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
8914 // If it is an alloca or global variable, it is always safe to load from.
8915 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V) || isa<GlobalVariable>(V)) return true;
8916
8917 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
8918 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008919 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
8920 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
8921 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008922 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
8923
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008924 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008925 --BBI;
8926
8927 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
8928 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
8929 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8930 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008931
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +00008932 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00008933 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00008934}
8935
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +00008936/// GetUnderlyingObject - Trace through a series of getelementptrs and bitcasts
8937/// until we find the underlying object a pointer is referring to or something
8938/// we don't understand. Note that the returned pointer may be offset from the
8939/// input, because we ignore GEP indices.
8940static Value *GetUnderlyingObject(Value *Ptr) {
8941 while (1) {
8942 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr)) {
8943 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast ||
8944 CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
8945 Ptr = CE->getOperand(0);
8946 else
8947 return Ptr;
8948 } else if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Ptr)) {
8949 Ptr = BCI->getOperand(0);
8950 } else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
8951 Ptr = GEP->getOperand(0);
8952 } else {
8953 return Ptr;
8954 }
8955 }
8956}
8957
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00008958Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
8959 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +00008960
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00008961 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00008962 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD);
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00008963 if (KnownAlign > LI.getAlignment())
8964 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
8965
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008966 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00008967 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008968 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
8969 return Res;
8970
8971 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
8972 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008973
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008974 if (&LI.getParent()->front() != &LI) {
8975 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI; --BBI;
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008976 // If the instruction immediately before this is a store to the same
8977 // address, do a simple form of store->load forwarding.
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008978 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))
8979 if (SI->getOperand(1) == LI.getOperand(0))
8980 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, SI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9c1f0fd2005-09-12 22:21:03 +00008981 if (LoadInst *LIB = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI))
8982 if (LIB->getOperand(0) == LI.getOperand(0))
8983 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, LIB);
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +00008984 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008985
8986 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op))
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008987 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008988 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
8989 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
8990 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
8991 // CFG.
8992 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
8993 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
8994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
8995 }
8996
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008997 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00008998 // load null/undef -> undef
8999 if ((C->isNullValue() || isa<UndefValue>(C))) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009000 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
9001 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
9002 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009003 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9004 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009006 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009007
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009008 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
9009 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009010 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009011 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009012
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009013 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
9014 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
9015 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
9016 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009017 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +00009018 if (Constant *V =
9019 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009020 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009021 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
9022 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
9023 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
9024 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
9025 // CFG.
9026 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
9027 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
9028 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9029 }
9030
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009031 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009032 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI))
9033 return Res;
9034 }
9035 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +00009036
9037 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
9038 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
9039 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(GetUnderlyingObject(Op))) {
9040 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
9041 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
9042 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
9043 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
9044 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
9045 }
9046 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +00009047
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +00009048 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009049 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
9050 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
9051 // exposes redundancy in the code.
9052 //
9053 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
9054 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
9055 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
9056 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
9057 // unconditionally.
9058 //
9059 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
9060 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +00009061 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
9062 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009063 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00009064 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009065 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +00009066 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009067 return new SelectInst(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
9068 }
9069
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +00009070 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
9071 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
9072 if (C->isNullValue()) {
9073 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
9074 return &LI;
9075 }
9076
9077 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
9078 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
9079 if (C->isNullValue()) {
9080 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
9081 return &LI;
9082 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +00009083 }
9084 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +00009085 return 0;
9086}
9087
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +00009088/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009089/// when possible.
9090static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
9091 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
9092 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
9093
9094 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9095 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
9096 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9097
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +00009098 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009099 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
9100 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
9101 // constants.
9102 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
9103 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
9104 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +00009105 Value* Idxs[2];
9106 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
9107 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009108 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
9109 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
9110 }
9111
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00009112 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
9113 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
9114 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009115
9116 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009117 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
9118 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009119 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009120 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009121 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
9122 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
9123 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
9124 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
9125 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009126 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +00009127 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00009128 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00009129 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
9130 }
9131 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009132 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009133 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009134 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +00009135 CastInst::create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
9136 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009137 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
9138 }
9139 }
9140 }
9141 return 0;
9142}
9143
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009144Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
9145 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
9146 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
9147
9148 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009149 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009150 ++NumCombined;
9151 return 0;
9152 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +00009153
9154 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
9155 // alloca dead.
9156 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
9157 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
9158 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9159 ++NumCombined;
9160 return 0;
9161 }
9162
9163 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
9164 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
9165 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
9166 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9167 ++NumCombined;
9168 return 0;
9169 }
9170 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009171
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009172 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009173 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD);
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +00009174 if (KnownAlign > SI.getAlignment())
9175 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
9176
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009177 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
9178 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
9179 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
9180 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
9181 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
9182 --ScanInsts) {
9183 --BBI;
9184
9185 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
9186 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
9187 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() && PrevSI->getOperand(1) == SI.getOperand(1)) {
9188 ++NumDeadStore;
9189 ++BBI;
9190 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
9191 continue;
9192 }
9193 break;
9194 }
9195
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009196 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
9197 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
9198 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
9199 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattnera54c7eb2007-09-07 05:33:03 +00009200 if (LI == Val && LI->getOperand(0) == Ptr && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009201 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9202 ++NumCombined;
9203 return 0;
9204 }
9205 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
9206 // may not be dead.
9207 break;
9208 }
9209
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009210 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +00009211 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009212 break;
9213 }
9214
9215
9216 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009217
9218 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
9219 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
9220 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
9221 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
9222 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009223 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009224 ++NumCombined;
9225 }
9226 return 0; // Do not modify these!
9227 }
9228
9229 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
9230 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009231 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009232 ++NumCombined;
9233 return 0;
9234 }
9235
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009236 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
9237 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009238 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009239 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9240 return Res;
9241 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009242 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +00009243 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
9244 return Res;
9245
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009246
9247 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
9248 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00009249 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009250 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009251 if (BI->isUnconditional())
9252 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
9253 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +00009254
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009255 return 0;
9256}
9257
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009258/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
9259/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
9260/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9261///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009262/// Simplify things like:
9263/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
9264/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
9265///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009266bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
9267 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
9268
9269 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
9270 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
9271 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009272 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009273
9274 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
9275 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009276 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
9277 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009278 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009279 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009280 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009281 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009282 return false;
9283
9284 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009285 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009286 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009287 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009288 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009289 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009290 return false;
9291
9292
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009293 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
9294 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009295 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009296 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009297 return false;
9298
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009299 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
9300 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
9301 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
9302 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
9303 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
9304 --BBI;
9305 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
9306 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9307 return false;
9308 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009309 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009310 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
9311 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
9312 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
9313 return false;
9314
9315 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009316 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
9317 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009318 for (;; --BBI) {
9319 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
9320 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
9321 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
9322 return false;
9323 break;
9324 }
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009325 // If we find something that may be using the stored value, or if we run
9326 // out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009327 if (isa<LoadInst>(BBI) || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
9328 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
9329 return false;
9330 }
9331
9332 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
9333 // make sure nothing reads the stored value in StoreBB.
9334 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
9335 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
9336 if (isa<LoadInst>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory())
9337 return false;
9338 }
9339 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009340
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009341 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009342 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
9343 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
9344 PHINode *PN = new PHINode(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
9345 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
9346 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009347 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
9348 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009349 }
9350
9351 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
9352 // insert it.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +00009353 BBI = DestBB->begin();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +00009354 while (isa<PHINode>(BBI)) ++BBI;
9355 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
9356 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
9357
9358 // Nuke the old stores.
9359 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
9360 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
9361 ++NumCombined;
9362 return true;
9363}
9364
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +00009365
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009366Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
9367 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00009368 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009369 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
9370 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
9371 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
9372 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
9373 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9374 BI.setCondition(X);
9375 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9376 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
9377 return &BI;
9378 }
9379
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009380 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
9381 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
9382 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9383 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9384 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
9385 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9386 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009387 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009388 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9389 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009390 // Swap Destinations and condition...
9391 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
9392 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9393 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009394 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009395 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009396 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009397 return &BI;
9398 }
9399
9400 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
9401 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
9402 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
9403 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
9404 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
9405 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
9406 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
9407 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009408 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009409 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
9410 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009411 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00009412 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009413 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
9414 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009415 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009416 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009417 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +00009418 return &BI;
9419 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009420
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +00009421 return 0;
9422}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +00009423
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009424Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
9425 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
9426 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
9427 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
9428 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
9429 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
9430 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009431 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009432 AddRHS));
9433 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009434 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +00009435 return &SI;
9436 }
9437 }
9438 return 0;
9439}
9440
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009441/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
9442/// is to leave as a vector operation.
9443static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
9444 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9445 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009446 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009447 if (isConstant) return true;
9448 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
9449 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
9450 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
9451 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
9452 return false;
9453 return true;
9454 }
9455 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
9456 if (!I) return false;
9457
9458 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
9459 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
9460 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
9461 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
9462 return true;
9463 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
9464 return true;
9465 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
9466 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
9467 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9468 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9469 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009470 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
9471 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
9472 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
9473 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
9474 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009475
9476 return false;
9477}
9478
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00009479/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
9480///
9481/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
9482/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009483static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
9484 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9485 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9486 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
9487 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
9488 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
9489
9490 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009491 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009492 for (unsigned i = 0, e = CP->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
9493 if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i)))
9494 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
9495 else
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009496 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(CP->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009497 return Result;
9498}
9499
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009500/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
9501/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
9502/// extracted from the vector.
9503static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009504 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
9505 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009506 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
9507 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009508 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9509
9510 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
9511 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
9512 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
9513 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009514 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009515 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
9516 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9517 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009518 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
9519 return 0;
9520 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009521
9522 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
9523 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009524 if (EltNo == IIElt)
9525 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009526
9527 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
9528 // vector input.
9529 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009530 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009531 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
9532 if (InEl < Width)
9533 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
9534 else if (InEl < Width*2)
9535 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - Width);
9536 else
9537 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009538 }
9539
9540 // Otherwise, we don't know.
9541 return 0;
9542}
9543
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009544Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009545
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009546 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009547 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9548 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9549
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009550 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +00009551 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
9552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
9553
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009554 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00009555 // If vector val is constant with uniform operands, replace EI
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009556 // with that operand
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009557 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009558 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009559 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
9560 op0 = 0;
9561 break;
9562 }
9563 if (op0)
9564 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009565 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009566
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009567 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
9568 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009569 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009570 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
9571 unsigned VectorWidth =
9572 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
9573
9574 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
9575 // crashing the code below.
9576 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
9577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
9578
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009579 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
9580 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
9581 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +00009582 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009583 uint64_t UndefElts;
9584 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009585 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009586 UndefElts)) {
9587 EI.setOperand(0, V);
9588 return &EI;
9589 }
9590 }
9591
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009592 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +00009594
9595 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
9596 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
9597 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
9598 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
9599 if (const VectorType *VT =
9600 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
9601 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
9602 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
9603 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
9604 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +00009605 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +00009606
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009607 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009608 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
9609 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
9610 // profitable to do so
9611 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +00009612 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
9613 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
9614 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
9615 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
9616 EI.getName()+".lhs");
9617 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
9618 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
9619 EI.getName()+".rhs");
9620 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
9621 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
9622 return BinaryOperator::create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
9623 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +00009624 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00009625 Value *Ptr = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, I->getOperand(0),
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009626 PointerType::get(EI.getType()), EI);
9627 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
Reid Spencerde331242006-11-29 01:11:01 +00009628 new GetElementPtrInst(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName() + ".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009629 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
9630 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009631 }
9632 }
9633 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
9634 // Extracting the inserted element?
9635 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
9636 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
9637 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
9638 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
9639 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
9640 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9641 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
9642 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
9643 return &EI;
9644 }
9645 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
9646 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
9647 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009648 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
9649 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009650 Value *Src;
9651 if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements())
9652 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
9653 else if (SrcIdx < SVI->getType()->getNumElements()*2) {
9654 SrcIdx -= SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
9655 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
9656 } else {
9657 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +00009658 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009659 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009660 }
9661 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +00009662 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009663 return 0;
9664}
9665
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009666/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
9667/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
9668/// Otherwise, return false.
9669static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
9670 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
9671 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
9672 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009673 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009674
9675 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009676 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009677 return true;
9678 } else if (V == LHS) {
9679 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009680 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009681 return true;
9682 } else if (V == RHS) {
9683 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009684 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009685 return true;
9686 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9687 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9688 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9689 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9690 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9691
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009692 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
9693 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009694 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009695
9696 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
9697 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9698 // transitively ok.
9699 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9700 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009701 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +00009702 return true;
9703 }
9704 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
9705 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009706 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9707 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009708 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009709
9710 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
9711 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
9712 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
9713 // transitively ok.
9714 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
9715 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
9716 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
9717 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009718 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009719 } else {
9720 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
9721 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009722 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009723
9724 }
9725 return true;
9726 }
9727 }
9728 }
9729 }
9730 }
9731 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
9732
9733 return false;
9734}
9735
9736/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
9737/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
9738/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009739static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009740 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009741 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009742 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009743 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009744 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009745
9746 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009747 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009748 return V;
9749 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009750 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009751 return V;
9752 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
9753 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
9754 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
9755 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
9756 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
9757
9758 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9759 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9760 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
9761 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009762 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
9763 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009764
9765 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
9766 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009767 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
9768 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
9769 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009770 Mask[InsertedIdx & (NumElts-1)] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009771 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009772 return V;
9773 }
9774
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009775 if (VecOp == RHS) {
9776 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009777 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
9778 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
9779 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009780 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009781 }
9782 return V;
9783 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009784
9785 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
9786 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
9787 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
9788 return EI->getOperand(0);
9789
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009790 }
9791 }
9792 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009793 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009794
9795 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
9796 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009797 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009798 return V;
9799}
9800
9801Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
9802 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
9803 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
9804 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
9805
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +00009806 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
9807 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
9808 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9809
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009810 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
9811 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
9812 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
9813 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
9814 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
9815 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +00009816 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
9817 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009818 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009819
9820 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
9821 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9822
9823 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
9824 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
9825
9826 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
9827 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
9828 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
9829 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
9830
9831 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
9832 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
9833 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
9834 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
9835 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
9836 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
9837 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
9838 // Build a new shuffle mask.
9839 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
9840 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009841 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009842 else {
9843 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009844 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009845 NumVectorElts));
9846 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009847 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009848 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009849 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009850 }
9851
9852 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
9853 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
9854 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
9855 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +00009856 Value *RHS = 0;
9857 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
9858 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
9859 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009860 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009861 }
9862 }
9863 }
9864
9865 return 0;
9866}
9867
9868
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009869Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
9870 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9871 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009872 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009873
9874 bool MadeChange = false;
9875
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009876 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009877 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009878 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
9879
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009880 // If we have shuffle(x, undef, mask) and any elements of mask refer to
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009881 // the undef, change them to undefs.
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009882 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(1))) {
9883 // Scan to see if there are any references to the RHS. If so, replace them
9884 // with undef element refs and set MadeChange to true.
9885 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9886 if (Mask[i] >= e && Mask[i] != 2*e) {
9887 Mask[i] = 2*e;
9888 MadeChange = true;
9889 }
9890 }
9891
9892 if (MadeChange) {
9893 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9894 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9895 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9896 if (Mask[i] == 2*e)
9897 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
9898 else
9899 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
9900 }
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009901 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattnere4929dd2007-01-05 07:36:08 +00009902 }
9903 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +00009904
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009905 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
9906 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
9907 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
9908 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009909 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
9910 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9911 }
9912
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009913 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
9914 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9915 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009916 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009917 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009918 else {
9919 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
9920 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS)))
9921 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
9922 else
9923 Mask[i] &= (e-1); // Force to LHS.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009924 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009925 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009926 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009927 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009928 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009929 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009930 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
9931 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009932 MadeChange = true;
9933 }
9934
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009935 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009936 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009937
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009938 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9939 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
9940 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
9941 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
9942
9943 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
9944 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +00009945 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009946
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +00009947 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
9948 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
9949 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009950
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009951 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
9952 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
9953 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
9954 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
9955 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
9956 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
9957 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
9958 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
9959 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
9960 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
9961 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
9962 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
9963
9964 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
9965 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
9966 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
9967 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
9968 else
9969 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
9970
9971 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
9972 // the replacement.
9973 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
9974 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
9975 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
9976 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009977 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009978 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009979 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009980 }
9981 }
9982 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
9983 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009984 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +00009985 }
9986 }
9987 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00009988
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +00009989 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
9990}
9991
9992
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +00009993
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +00009994
9995/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
9996/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
9997/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
9998/// end of its block.
9999static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
10000 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
10001
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000010002 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
10003 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory()) return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010004
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010005 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000010006 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
10007 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010008 return false;
10009
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010010 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
10011 // the end of block that could change the value.
10012 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010013 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = LI, E = LI->getParent()->end();
10014 Scan != E; ++Scan)
10015 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
10016 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000010017 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010018
10019 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->begin();
10020 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) ++InsertPos;
10021
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000010022 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010023 ++NumSunkInst;
10024 return true;
10025}
10026
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010027
10028/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
10029/// all reachable code to the worklist.
10030///
10031/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
10032/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
10033/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
10034/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
10035/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
10036///
10037static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000010038 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010039 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010040 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010041 std::vector<BasicBlock*> Worklist;
10042 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010043
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010044 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10045 BB = Worklist.back();
10046 Worklist.pop_back();
10047
10048 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
10049 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
10050
10051 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
10052 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010053
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010054 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
10055 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
10056 ++NumDeadInst;
10057 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
10058 Inst->eraseFromParent();
10059 continue;
10060 }
10061
10062 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
10063 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
10064 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
10065 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
10066 ++NumConstProp;
10067 Inst->eraseFromParent();
10068 continue;
10069 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000010070
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010071 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010072 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000010073
10074 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
10075 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
10076 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
10077 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
10078 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
10079 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
10080 Worklist.push_back(BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal));
10081 continue;
10082 }
10083 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
10084 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
10085 // See if this is an explicit destination.
10086 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
10087 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
10088 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(i));
10089 continue;
10090 }
10091
10092 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
10093 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
10094 continue;
10095 }
10096 }
10097
10098 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
10099 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010100 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010101}
10102
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010103bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010104 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000010105 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010106
10107 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
10108 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010109
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010110 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010111 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
10112 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
10113 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000010114 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010115 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000010116
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010117 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
10118 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
10119 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
10120 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
10121 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
10122 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
10123 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
10124 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000010125
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010126 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000010127 ++NumDeadInst;
10128
10129 if (!I->use_empty())
10130 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
10131 I->eraseFromParent();
10132 }
10133 }
10134 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010135
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010136 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
10137 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
10138 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010139
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010140 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010141 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010142 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010143 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010144 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010145 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010146
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010147 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000010148
10149 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010150 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010151 continue;
10152 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010153
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010154 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000010155 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010156 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000010157
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000010158 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010159 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000010160 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
10161
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010162 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000010163 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010164 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010165 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000010166 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010167
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000010168 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
10169 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
10170 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
10171 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
10172 if (UserParent != BB) {
10173 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
10174 // See if the user is one of our successors.
10175 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
10176 if (*SI == UserParent) {
10177 UserIsSuccessor = true;
10178 break;
10179 }
10180
10181 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
10182 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
10183 // otherwise), we can keep going.
10184 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
10185 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
10186 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
10187 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
10188 }
10189 }
10190
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010191 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010192#ifndef NDEBUG
10193 std::string OrigI;
10194#endif
10195 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010196 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000010197 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010198 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010199 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000010200 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
10201 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010202
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010203 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
10204 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
10205
10206 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010207 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010208 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010209
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010210 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
10211 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010212
10213 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
10214 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010215 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
10216
10217 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
10218 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
10219 ++InsertPos;
10220
10221 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010222
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010223 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
10224 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010225 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000010226
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010227 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
10228 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010229 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000010230
10231 // Erase the old instruction.
10232 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010233 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010234#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000010235 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
10236 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000010237#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000010238
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010239 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
10240 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010241 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
10242 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
10243 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010244 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010245
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000010246 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000010247 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010248 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000010249 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000010250 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010251 AddToWorkList(I);
10252 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010253 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000010254 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010255 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010256 }
10257 }
10258
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010259 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000010260
10261 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
10262 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010263 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010264}
10265
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010266
10267bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010268 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
10269
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000010270 bool EverMadeChange = false;
10271
10272 // Iterate while there is work to do.
10273 unsigned Iteration = 0;
10274 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
10275 EverMadeChange = true;
10276 return EverMadeChange;
10277}
10278
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000010279FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000010280 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000010281}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000010282